blob: ea326d19a7e1d6d61781eb561d1424246d2a9e73 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucfe14662017-11-19 09:55:29 +01007 2017/11/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112
1131. Quick reminder about HTTP
114----------------------------
115
116When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
117fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
118on almost anything found in the contents.
119
120However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
121formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
122correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
123
124
1251.1. The HTTP transaction model
126-------------------------------
127
128The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100129to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
131connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
132will involve a new connection :
133
134 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
135
136In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
137establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
138by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
139length.
140
141Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
142to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
143however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
144response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
145header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
146
147 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
148
149Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
150power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
151but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200152a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
154A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
155keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
156second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
157page :
158
159 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
160
161This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
162latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
163correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
164the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100165server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100167By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
168connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
169leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
170start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200171
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100172HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
173 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
174 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
175 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
176 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
177 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
178 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180
1811.2. HTTP request
182-----------------
183
184First, let's consider this HTTP request :
185
186 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100187 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
189 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
190 3 User-agent: my small browser
191 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
192 5 Accept: image/png
193
194
1951.2.1. The Request line
196-----------------------
197
198Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
199
200 - a METHOD : GET
201 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
202 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
203
204All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
205which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
206followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
207is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
208desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
209the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
210
211The URI itself can have several forms :
212
213 - A "relative URI" :
214
215 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
216
217 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
218 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
219
220 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
221
222 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
223
224 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
225 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
226 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
227 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
228 must accept this form too.
229
230 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
231 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
232 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
235 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
236 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
237 other protocols too.
238
239In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
240mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
241on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
242It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
243specific to the language, framework or application in use.
244
245
2461.2.2. The request headers
247--------------------------
248
249The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
250beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
251an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
252Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
253values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
254encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
255the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
256define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
257
258Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
259their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
260"Connection:" header).
261
262The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
263that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
264is one valid form of empty line.
265
266Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
267headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
268about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
269application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
270
271Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000272 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
274 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
275 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
276
277
2781.3. HTTP response
279------------------
280
281An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
282messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
283
284 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100285 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
287 2 Content-length: 350
288 3 Content-Type: text/html
289
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200290As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
291codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
292response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100293continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
294the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
295following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
296sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
297(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
298correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
299such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
300state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
301over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
302if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
303information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305
3061.3.1. The Response line
307------------------------
308
309Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
310
311 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
312 - a status code : 200
313 - a reason : OK
314
315The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200317 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
318 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
319 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
320 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
321
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000322Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
325messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
326or "Authentication Required".
327
328Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
329
330 Code When / reason
331 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
332 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100335 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
336 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337 400 for an invalid or too large request
338 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
339 accessing the stats page)
340 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
341 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
342 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
343 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
344 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
345 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
346 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
347 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
348 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
349
350The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3514.2).
352
353
3541.3.2. The response headers
355---------------------------
356
357Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
358the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
359details.
360
361
3622. Configuring HAProxy
363----------------------
364
3652.1. Configuration file format
366------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200367
368HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
369
370 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
371 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
372 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
373 "frontend" and "backend".
374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100375The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
376referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200377delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003802.2. Quoting and escaping
381-------------------------
382
383HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
384many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
385with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
386single quotes.
387
388If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
389them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
390escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
391
392Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
393
394 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
395 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
396 \\ to use a backslash
397 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
398 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
399
400Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
401the interpretation of:
402
403 space as a parameter separator
404 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
405 # hash as a comment start
406
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200407Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
408-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
409backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
410
411Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412quoting.
413
414Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
415nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
416
417Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
418equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
419
420 Example:
421 # those are equivalents:
422 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
424 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
426 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
427
428 # those are equivalents:
429 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
432 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
433
434
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004352.3. Environment variables
436--------------------------
437
438HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
439interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
440configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
441optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
442shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
443underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
444
445 Example:
446
447 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
448
449 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
450
451 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
452
453
4542.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200455----------------
456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100457Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100458values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
459otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
460numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
461for every keyword. Supported units are :
462
463 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
464 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
465 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
466 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
467 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
468 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
469
470
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004712.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200472-------------
473
474 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
475 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
476 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
477 global
478 daemon
479 maxconn 256
480
481 defaults
482 mode http
483 timeout connect 5000ms
484 timeout client 50000ms
485 timeout server 50000ms
486
487 frontend http-in
488 bind *:80
489 default_backend servers
490
491 backend servers
492 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
493
494
495 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
496 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
497 global
498 daemon
499 maxconn 256
500
501 defaults
502 mode http
503 timeout connect 5000ms
504 timeout client 50000ms
505 timeout server 50000ms
506
507 listen http-in
508 bind *:80
509 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
510
511
512Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
513
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100514 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200515
516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005173. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518--------------------
519
520Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
521are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
522of them have command-line equivalents.
523
524The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
525
526 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200528 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200529 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200531 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200532 - description
533 - deviceatlas-json-file
534 - deviceatlas-log-level
535 - deviceatlas-separator
536 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900537 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200538 - gid
539 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100540 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200541 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200542 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100543 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200544 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200546 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200547 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100549 - presetenv
550 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200551 - uid
552 - ulimit-n
553 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100554 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200555 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200556 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-bind-options
558 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
559 - ssl-default-server-options
560 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100561 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100562 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100563 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100564 - 51degrees-data-file
565 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200566 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200567 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100568 - wurfl-data-file
569 - wurfl-information-list
570 - wurfl-information-list-separator
571 - wurfl-engine-mode
572 - wurfl-cache-size
573 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200576 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200578 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100579 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100580 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100581 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200582 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200583 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200584 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - noepoll
587 - nokqueue
588 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100589 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300590 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000591 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200592 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200593 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200594 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000595 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000596 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200597 - tune.buffers.limit
598 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200600 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100601 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200602 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200603 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200604 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100605 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200606 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200607 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100608 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100609 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100610 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100611 - tune.lua.session-timeout
612 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200613 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100614 - tune.maxaccept
615 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200616 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200617 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200618 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100619 - tune.rcvbuf.client
620 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100621 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100622 - tune.sndbuf.client
623 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100624 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100625 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200626 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100627 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200628 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200629 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100630 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200631 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100632 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200633 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
634 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
635 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100636 - tune.zlib.memlevel
637 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100638
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 * Debugging
640 - debug
641 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642
643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006443.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645------------------------------------
646
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200647ca-base <dir>
648 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200649 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
650 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200651
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200652chroot <jail dir>
653 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
654 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
655 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
656 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
657 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
658 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100659
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100660cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
661 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
662 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
663 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
664 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
665 set. These sets have the format
666
667 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
668
669 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
670 word size. any process IDs above nbrpoc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
671 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
672 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100673 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
674 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
675 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
676 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100677 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
678 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
679 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
680 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
681 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
682 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100683
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100684 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
685 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
686 on the machine's word size.
687
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100688 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100689 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
690 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
691 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
692 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
693 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
694 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100695
696 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100697 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
698
699 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
700 # first 4 CPUs
701
702 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
703 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
704 # word size.
705
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100706 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100707 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100708 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
709 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
710 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
711
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
713 # and so on.
714 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
715 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
716 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
717
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100718 # bind each process to exaclty one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
719 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
720 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
721 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
722
723 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
724 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
725 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
726
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100727 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
728 # and a thread range.
729 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
730 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
731 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
732
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200733crt-base <dir>
734 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
735 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
736 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738daemon
739 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
740 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100741 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
742 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200743
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200744deviceatlas-json-file <path>
745 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
746 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
747
748deviceatlas-log-level <value>
749 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
750 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
751
752deviceatlas-separator <char>
753 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
754 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
755
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100756deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200757 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
758 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
759 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100760
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900761external-check
762 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
763 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
764 See "option external-check".
765
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766gid <number>
767 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
768 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
769 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100770 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
771 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100773
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100774hard-stop-after <time>
775 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
776
777 Arguments :
778 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
779 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
780 SIGUSR1 signal.
781
782 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
783 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
784 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
785
786 Example:
787 global
788 hard-stop-after 30s
789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790group <group name>
791 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
792 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100793
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200794log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200795 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
796 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100797 configured with "log global".
798
799 <address> can be one of:
800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100801 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100802 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
803 port).
804
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100805 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
806 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
807 port).
808
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100809 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
810 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
811 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
812 writeable).
813
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200814 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
815 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100816
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200817 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
818 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
819 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
820 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
821 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
822 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
823 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
824 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
825 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
826 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200827 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
828 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200829
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200830 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
831 one of the following :
832
833 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
834 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
835
836 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
837 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
838
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100839 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840
841 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
842 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
843 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
844
845 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200846 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
847 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
848 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
849 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
850 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
851 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200853 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100855log-send-hostname [<string>]
856 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
857 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
858 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
859 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
860 the logs.
861
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000862log-tag <string>
863 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
864 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
865 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100866 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000867
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100868lua-load <file>
869 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
870 used multiple times.
871
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200872master-worker [exit-on-failure]
873 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
874 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
875 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
876 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
877 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
878 systemd.
879 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
880 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
881 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
882 the whole process.
883
884 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
885
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200886nbproc <number>
887 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
888 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
889 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
890 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
891 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
892
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200893nbthread <number>
894 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
895 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
896 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
897 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
898 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
899
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200900pidfile <pidfile>
901 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
902 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
903 starting the process. See also "daemon".
904
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100905presetenv <name> <value>
906 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
907 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
908 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
909 and "unsetenv".
910
911resetenv [<name> ...]
912 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
913 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
914 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
915 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
916 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
917 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
918 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
919 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
920
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100921stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200922 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
923 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
924 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
925 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
926 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
927 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100928 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100929 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
930 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
931 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
932 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200933
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200934server-state-base <directory>
935 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200936 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
937 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200938
939server-state-file <file>
940 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
941 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
942 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
943 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
944 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
945 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
946 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
947 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200948 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
949 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200950
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100951setenv <name> <value>
952 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
953 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
954 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
955 and "unsetenv".
956
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100957ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
958 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
959 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300960 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100961 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
962 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
963 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
964 "bind" keyword for more information.
965
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100966ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
967 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
968 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
969 keyword to see available options.
970
971 Example:
972 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200973 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100974
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100975ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
976 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
977 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300978 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100979 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
980 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
981 information.
982
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100983ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
985 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
986 keyword to see available options.
987
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200988ssl-dh-param-file <file>
989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
990 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
991 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
992 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
993 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200994 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
995 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
996 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
997 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200998 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
999 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1000 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1001
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001002ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1003 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1004 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1005 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1006
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001007stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1008 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1009 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1010 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001011 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001012 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001013
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001014 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1015 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1016 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001017
1018stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1019 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1020 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001021 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001022
1023stats maxconn <connections>
1024 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1025 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1026
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027uid <number>
1028 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1029 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1030 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1031 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1032
1033ulimit-n <number>
1034 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1035 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1036 option.
1037
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001038unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1039 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1040
1041 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1042 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1043 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1044 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1045 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1046 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1047 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1048 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1049 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1050 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1051
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001052unsetenv [<name> ...]
1053 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1054 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1055 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1056 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1057 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1058 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1059 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061user <user name>
1062 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1063 See also "uid" and "group".
1064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001065node <name>
1066 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1067
1068 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1069 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1070 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1071 traffic.
1072
1073description <text>
1074 Add a text that describes the instance.
1075
1076 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1077 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1078 "<" and ">" characters.
1079
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100108051degrees-data-file <file path>
1081 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1082 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1083
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001084 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001085 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1086
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000108751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001088 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1089 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1090 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1091
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001092 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001093 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1094
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200109551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001096 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1097 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1098
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001099 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1100 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1101
110251degrees-cache-size <number>
1103 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1104 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1105 By default, this cache is disabled.
1106
1107 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001108 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1109
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001110wurfl-data-file <file path>
1111 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1112 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1113
1114 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1115 with USE_WURFL=1.
1116
1117wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1118 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1119 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1120 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1121
1122 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1123
1124 Valid WURFL properties are:
1125 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1126
1127 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1128 device.
1129
1130 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1131 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1132
1133 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1134 particular web request.
1135
1136 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1137 used Libwurfl API version.
1138
1139 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1140 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1141 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1142
1143 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1144 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1145
1146 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1147 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1148
1149 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1150
1151 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1152
1153 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1154 with USE_WURFL=1.
1155
1156wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1157 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1158 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1159
1160 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1161 with USE_WURFL=1.
1162
1163wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1164 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1165 thus before the chroot.
1166
1167 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1168 with USE_WURFL=1.
1169
1170wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1171 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1172 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1173 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1174 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1175 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1176 mode is enabled by default.
1177
1178 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1179 with USE_WURFL=1.
1180
1181wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1182 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1183 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1184 - "0" : no cache is used.
1185 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1186 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1187 the highest performing option.
1188
1189 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1190 with USE_WURFL=1.
1191
1192wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1193 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1194 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1195
1196 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1197 with USE_WURFL=1.
1198
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012003.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001201-----------------------
1202
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001203max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1204 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1205 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1206 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1207 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1208 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1209 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1210 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1211 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1212
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001213maxconn <number>
1214 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1215 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1216 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001217 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1218 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1219 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1220 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001221 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1222 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1223 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1224 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1225 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001226
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001227maxconnrate <number>
1228 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1229 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1230 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1231 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1232 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1233 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1234 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1235 fairness.
1236
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001237maxcomprate <number>
1238 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001239 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001240 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1241 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1242 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1243 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1244 default value.
1245
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001246maxcompcpuusage <number>
1247 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1248 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1249 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1250 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1251 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1252 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1253 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1254 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1255
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001256maxpipes <number>
1257 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1258 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1259 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1260 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1261 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1262 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1263
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001264maxsessrate <number>
1265 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1266 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1267 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1268 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1269 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1270 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1271 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1272 fairness.
1273
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001274maxsslconn <number>
1275 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1276 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1277 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1278 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1279 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1280 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1281 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001282 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1283 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1284 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1285 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1286 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1287 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1288 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001289
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001290maxsslrate <number>
1291 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1292 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1293 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1294 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1295 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1296 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1297 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1298 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1299 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1300 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1301
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001302maxzlibmem <number>
1303 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1304 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1305 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001306 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1307 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1308 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1309
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001310noepoll
1311 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1312 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001313 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001314
1315nokqueue
1316 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1317 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1318 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1319
1320nopoll
1321 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1322 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001324 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001325
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001326nosplice
1327 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1328 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1329 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001330 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001331 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1332 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1333 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1334 "option splice-response".
1335
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001336nogetaddrinfo
1337 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1338 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1339
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001340noreuseport
1341 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1342 command line argument "-dR".
1343
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001344spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001345 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1346 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1347 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1348 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1349 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1350 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001351
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001352ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1353 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1354 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1355 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1356 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1357 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1358 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1359 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1360 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1361 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1362 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1363 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1364 openssl configuration file uses:
1365 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1366
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001367ssl-mode-async
1368 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001369 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001370 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1371 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1372 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1373 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1374 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001375
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001376tune.buffers.limit <number>
1377 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1378 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1379 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1380 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1381 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1382 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1383 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1384 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1385 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1386 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1387 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1388 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1389 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1390 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1391 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1392
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001393tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1394 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1395 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1396 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1397 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1398
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001399tune.bufsize <number>
1400 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1401 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1402 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1403 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1404 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1405 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1406 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001407 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1408 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1409 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001410 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1411 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001412
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001413tune.chksize <number>
1414 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1415 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1416 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1417 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1418 checks whenever possible.
1419
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001420tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1421 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1422 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1423 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1424 this value. The default value is 1.
1425
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001426tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1427 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1428 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1429 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1430 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1431 change it.
1432
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001433tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1434 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
1435 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgement from haproxy. This setting
1436 only affects payload contents (ie: the body of POST requests), not headers.
1437 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1438 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1439 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1440 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1441 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1442
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001443tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1444 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1445 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1446 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1447 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1448 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1449 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1450 recommended not to change this value.
1451
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001452tune.http.cookielen <number>
1453 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1454 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1455 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1456 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1457 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1458 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1459 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1460 to change this value.
1461
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001462tune.http.logurilen <number>
1463 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1464 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1465 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1466 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1467 configuration directives too.
1468 The default value is 1024.
1469
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001470tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1471 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1472 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1473 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1474 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1475 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1476 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001477 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1478 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1479 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001480
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001481tune.idletimer <timeout>
1482 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1483 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1484 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1485 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1486 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1487 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1488 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1489 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1490 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1491
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001492tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1493 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001494 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001495 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1496 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1497 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1498 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1499 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1500
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001501tune.lua.maxmem
1502 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1503 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1504 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1505 memory.
1506
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001507tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1508 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001509 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1510 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1511 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001512
1513tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1514 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1515 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1516 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1517 check servers.
1518
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001519tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1520 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1521 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1522 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1523 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1524
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001525tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001526 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1527 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1528 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1529 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1530 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1531 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1532 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1533 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1534 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1535 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001536
1537tune.maxpollevents <number>
1538 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1539 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1540 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1541 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1542 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1543
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001544tune.maxrewrite <number>
1545 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1546 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1547 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1548 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1549 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1550 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1551 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1552 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1553 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1554 bufsize.
1555
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001556tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1557 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1558 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1559 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1560 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1561 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1562 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1563 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1564 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1565 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1566 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1567 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1568 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1569 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1570 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1571 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1572 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1573 setting this parameter to 0.
1574
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001575tune.pipesize <number>
1576 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1577 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1578 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1579 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1580 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1581 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1582
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001583tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1584tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1585 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1586 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1587 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1588 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1589 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1590 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1591 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1592
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001593tune.recv_enough <number>
1594 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1595 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1596 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1597 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1598 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1599
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001600tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1601tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1602 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1603 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1604 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1605 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1606 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1607 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1608 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1609 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1610 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1611 notifying haproxy again.
1612
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001613tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001614 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1615 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1616 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001617 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001618 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1619 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1620 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1621 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1622 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001623 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1624 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001625
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001626tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1627 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1628 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1629 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1630 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1631 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1632 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1633
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001634tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1635 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001636 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001637 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1638 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1639 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1640 being used for too long.
1641
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001642tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1643 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1644 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1645 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1646 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1647 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1648 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1649 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1650 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1651 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1652 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001653 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1654 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001655
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001656tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1657 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1658 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1659 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1660 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1661 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1662 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1663 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001664 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1665 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001666
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001667tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1668 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1669 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1670 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1671 1000 entries.
1672
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001673tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1674 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1675 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1676 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1677
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001678tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001679tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001680tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1681tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1682tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001683 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1684 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1685 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1686 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1687 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1688 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1689 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1690 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001691
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001692 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1693 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1694 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1695 all available space is consumed.
1696 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1697 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1698 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001699
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001700tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1701 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001702 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001703 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1704 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1705 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1706
1707tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1708 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1709 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1710 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1711 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017133.3. Debugging
1714--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001715
1716debug
1717 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1718 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1719 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1720 system startup.
1721
1722quiet
1723 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1724 line argument "-q".
1725
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017273.4. Userlists
1728--------------
1729It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1730http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1731it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1732
1733userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001734 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001735 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1736
1737group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001738 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001739 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1740 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1741
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001742user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1743 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001744 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1745 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001746 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1747 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1748 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1749 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001750
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001751 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1752 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1753 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1754 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1755 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1756 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1757 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1758 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1759 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001760
1761 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001762 userlist L1
1763 group G1 users tiger,scott
1764 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001765
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001766 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1767 user scott insecure-password elgato
1768 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001769
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001770 userlist L2
1771 group G1
1772 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001773
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001774 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1775 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1776 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001777
1778 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001779
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001780
17813.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001782----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001783It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1784several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1785instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1786values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1787automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1788In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1789using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1790tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1791reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1792Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1793that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1794each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001795
1796peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001797 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001798 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1799
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001800disabled
1801 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1802 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1803 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1804
1805enable
1806 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1807
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001808peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1809 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1810 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1811 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1812 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1813 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1814 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1815
1816 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1817 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1818
1819 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1820 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1821 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1822 across all peers.
1823
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001824 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1825 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001826
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001827 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001828 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001829 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1830 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1831 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001832
1833 backend mybackend
1834 mode tcp
1835 balance roundrobin
1836 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1837 stick on src
1838
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001839 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1840 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001841
1842
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090018433.6. Mailers
1844------------
1845It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1846If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1847in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1848
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001849mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001850 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1851 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1852
1853mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1854 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1855
1856 Example:
1857 mailers mymailers
1858 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1859 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1860
1861 backend mybackend
1862 mode tcp
1863 balance roundrobin
1864
1865 email-alert mailers mymailers
1866 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1867 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1868
1869 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1870 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1871
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001872timeout mail <time>
1873 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1874 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1875 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1876 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1877
1878 Example:
1879 mailers mymailers
1880 timeout mail 20s
1881 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001884----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001885
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001886Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001887 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888 - frontend <name>
1889 - backend <name>
1890 - listen <name>
1891
1892A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1893its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1894section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001895section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001896
1897A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1898connections.
1899
1900A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1901to forward incoming connections.
1902
1903A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1904parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1907'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1908case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1909
1910Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1911logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1912proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1913However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1914name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1915
1916Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1917and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001918bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001919protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1920modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1921arbitrary criteria.
1922
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001923In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1924a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1925the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1926
1927 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1928 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1929 between responses and new requests.
1930
1931 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1932 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1933 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1934 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1935
1936 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1937 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1938 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1939
1940 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1941 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1942 client-facing connection remains open.
1943
1944 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1945 after the end of the response.
1946
1947The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1948frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1949following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1950weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1951
1952 Backend mode
1953
1954 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1955 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1956 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1957 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1958 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1959 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1960 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1961 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1962 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1963 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1964 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001966
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019684.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1969--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001971The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1972limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1973they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1974limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001975marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001976option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001977and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1978with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1979specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001980
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001981
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001982 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1983------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1984acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001985appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001986backlog X X X -
1987balance X - X X
1988bind - X X -
1989bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001990block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001991capture cookie - X X -
1992capture request header - X X -
1993capture response header - X X -
1994clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001995compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001996contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1997cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001998declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001999default-server X - X X
2000default_backend X X X -
2001description - X X X
2002disabled X X X X
2003dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002004email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002005email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002006email-alert mailers X X X X
2007email-alert myhostname X X X X
2008email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002009enabled X X X X
2010errorfile X X X X
2011errorloc X X X X
2012errorloc302 X X X X
2013-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2014errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002015force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002016filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002017fullconn X - X X
2018grace X X X X
2019hash-type X - X X
2020http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002021http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002022http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002023http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002024http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002025http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002026http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002027id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002028ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002029load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002030log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002031log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002032log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002033log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002034max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002035maxconn X X X -
2036mode X X X X
2037monitor fail - X X -
2038monitor-net X X X -
2039monitor-uri X X X -
2040option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2041option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2042option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2043option allbackups (*) X - X X
2044option checkcache (*) X - X X
2045option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2046option contstats (*) X X X -
2047option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2048option dontlognull (*) X X X -
2049option forceclose (*) X X X X
2050-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2051option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002052option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002053option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002054option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002055option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002056option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002057option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002058option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002059option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2060option httpchk X - X X
2061option httpclose (*) X X X X
2062option httplog X X X X
2063option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002064option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002065option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002066option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002067option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2068option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2069option logasap (*) X X X -
2070option mysql-check X - X X
2071option nolinger (*) X X X X
2072option originalto X X X X
2073option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002074option pgsql-check X - X X
2075option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002076option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002077option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002078option smtpchk X - X X
2079option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2080option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2081option splice-request (*) X X X X
2082option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002083option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002084option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2085option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2086-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002087option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002088option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2089option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2090option tcpka X X X X
2091option tcplog X X X X
2092option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002093external-check command X - X X
2094external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002095persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2096rate-limit sessions X X X -
2097redirect - X X X
2098redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2099redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2100reqadd - X X X
2101reqallow - X X X
2102reqdel - X X X
2103reqdeny - X X X
2104reqiallow - X X X
2105reqidel - X X X
2106reqideny - X X X
2107reqipass - X X X
2108reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002109reqitarpit - X X X
2110reqpass - X X X
2111reqrep - X X X
2112-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002113reqtarpit - X X X
2114retries X - X X
2115rspadd - X X X
2116rspdel - X X X
2117rspdeny - X X X
2118rspidel - X X X
2119rspideny - X X X
2120rspirep - X X X
2121rsprep - X X X
2122server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002123server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002124server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002125source X - X X
2126srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002127stats admin - X X X
2128stats auth X X X X
2129stats enable X X X X
2130stats hide-version X X X X
2131stats http-request - X X X
2132stats realm X X X X
2133stats refresh X X X X
2134stats scope X X X X
2135stats show-desc X X X X
2136stats show-legends X X X X
2137stats show-node X X X X
2138stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002139-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2140stick match - - X X
2141stick on - - X X
2142stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002143stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002144stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002145tcp-check connect - - X X
2146tcp-check expect - - X X
2147tcp-check send - - X X
2148tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002149tcp-request connection - X X -
2150tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002151tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002152tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002153tcp-response content - - X X
2154tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002155timeout check X - X X
2156timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002157timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002158timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2159timeout connect X - X X
2160timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2161timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2162timeout http-request X X X X
2163timeout queue X - X X
2164timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002165timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002166timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2167timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002168timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002169transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002170unique-id-format X X X -
2171unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002172use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002173use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002174------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2175 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2179---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002180
2181This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2182
2183
2184acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2185 Declare or complete an access list.
2186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2187 no | yes | yes | yes
2188 Example:
2189 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2190 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2191 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002193 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194
2195
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002196appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2197 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2200 no | no | yes | yes
2201 Arguments :
2202 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2203 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2204
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002205 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206 checked in each cookie value.
2207
2208 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2209 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2210 milliseconds.
2211
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002212 request-learn
2213 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2214 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2215 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2216 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2217 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2218 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2219
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002220 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2221 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2222 data following this prefix.
2223
2224 Example :
2225 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2226
2227 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2228 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2229
2230 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2231 2 modes are currently supported :
2232 - path-parameters :
2233 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2234 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2235 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2236 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2237 - query-string :
2238 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2239 query string.
2240
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002241 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2242 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2243 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002245 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2246 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002247
2248
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002249backlog <conns>
2250 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2252 yes | yes | yes | no
2253 Arguments :
2254 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2255 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002256 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002257
2258 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2259 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2260 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2261 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2262 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2263 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2264 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2265 backlog parameter.
2266
2267 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2268 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2269 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2270
2271 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2272
2273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002274balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002275balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002276 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2278 yes | no | yes | yes
2279 Arguments :
2280 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2281 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2282 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2283 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2284
2285 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2286 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2287 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2288 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002289 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002290 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002291 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2292 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2293 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2294 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2295 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2296 it, so that you don't worry.
2297
2298 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2299 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2300 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2301 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2302 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2303 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2304 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2305 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002307 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2308 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2309 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2310 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2311 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2312 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2313 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2314 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2315
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002316 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002317 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002318 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2319 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002320 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002321 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2322 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2323 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2324 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2325 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002326 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2327 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2328 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2329 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2330 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2331 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2334 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2335 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2336 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2337 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2338 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2339 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2340 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002341 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002343 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2344 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2345 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002346
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002347 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2348 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2349 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2350 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2351 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2352 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2353 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2354 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2355 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2356 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2357 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2358 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002359
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002360 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002361 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2362 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2363 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2364 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2365 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2366 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2367 URIs start with a leading "/".
2368
2369 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2370 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2371 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2372 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002374 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002375 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2376
2377 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002378 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2379 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002380 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2381 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2382 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2383 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002384 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002385 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2386 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002387
2388 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2389 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2390 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2391 server will receive the request.
2392
2393 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2394 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2395 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2396 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2397 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002398 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2399 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2400 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002402 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2403 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2404 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2405 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2406 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002408 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002409 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2410 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2411 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2412
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002413 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2414 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2415 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2416
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002417 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002418 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002419 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2420 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2421 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2422 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2423 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2424 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002425 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002426 used instead.
2427
2428 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2429 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2430 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2431 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2432
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002433 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2434 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2435 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2436
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002437 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002440 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2441 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002442
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002443 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2444 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2445 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002446
2447 Examples :
2448 balance roundrobin
2449 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002450 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002451 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2452 balance hdr(host)
2453 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002454
2455 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2456 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002458 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002459 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2460 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2461 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2462 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2463
2464 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2465 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2466 defaults to 16 kB.
2467
2468 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2469 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2470
2471 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2472 Round Robin.
2473
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002474 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002475 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2476 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2477 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2478
2479 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2480
2481 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002482 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002483 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2484 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2485 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002487 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002488
2489
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002490bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2491bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2494 no | yes | yes | no
2495 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002496 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2497 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2498 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2499 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002500 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002501 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2502 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2503 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2504 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2505 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2506 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2507 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002508 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2509 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2510 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2511 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2512 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2513 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2514 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002515 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2516 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2517 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002518 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2519 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2520 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002521
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002522 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2523 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002524 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2525 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2526 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002527 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2528 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2529 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2530 the range.
2531
2532 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2533 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2534 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2535 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2536 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2537 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2538 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002539 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002540 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002541
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002542 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2543 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2544 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2545 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2546 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2547 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2548 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2549 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2550
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002551 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2552 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2553 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2554 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2557 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2558 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2559 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2560 in a frontend.
2561
2562 Example :
2563 listen http_proxy
2564 bind :80,:443
2565 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002566 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002567
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002568 listen http_https_proxy
2569 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002570 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002571
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002572 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2573 bind ipv6@:80
2574 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2575 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2576
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002577 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002578 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002579
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002580 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2581 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2582 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2583 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2584 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2585
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002586 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002587 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
2589
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002590bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002591 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2593 yes | yes | yes | yes
2594 Arguments :
2595 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2596 may be used to override a default value.
2597
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002598 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002599 option may be combined with other numbers.
2600
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002601 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002602 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2603 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2604 missing from all processes.
2605
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002606 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002607 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002608 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2609 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2610 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2611 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2612 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002613 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002614
2615 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2616 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2617 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2618 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2619 and 'even' instances.
2620
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002621 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2622 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2623 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2624 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002625
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002626 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2627 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2628
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002629 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2630 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2631 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2632
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002633 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2634 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2635
2636 Example :
2637 listen app_ip1
2638 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002639 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002640
2641 listen app_ip2
2642 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002643 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002644
2645 listen management
2646 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002647 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002648
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002649 listen management
2650 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2651 bind-process 1-4
2652
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002653 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002654
2655
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002656block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002657 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2659 no | yes | yes | yes
2660
2661 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2662 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002663 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002664 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002666 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2667 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2668 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002670 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2671 "http-request deny" instead.
2672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673 Example:
2674 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2675 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2676 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002677 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2678 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2679 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002681 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2682 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2683 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002684
2685capture cookie <name> len <length>
2686 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2688 no | yes | yes | no
2689 Arguments :
2690 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2691 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2692 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2693 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2694 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2695
2696 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2697 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2698 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2699 right if it exceeds <length>.
2700
2701 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2702 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2703 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2704 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2705
2706 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2707 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2708 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2709
2710 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2711 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2712 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002713 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2714 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2715 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716
2717 Example:
2718 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2719
2720 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002721 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722
2723
2724capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002725 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2727 no | yes | yes | no
2728 Arguments :
2729 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002730 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002731 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2732 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2733 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2734
2735 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2736 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2737 it exceeds <length>.
2738
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002739 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2741 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002742 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2743 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2744 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2745 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002746 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002747 environments to find where the request came from.
2748
2749 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2750 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2751 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2752 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002753
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002754 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2755 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2756 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2757 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2758 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
2760 Example:
2761 capture request header Host len 15
2762 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002763 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002765 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766 about logging.
2767
2768
2769capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002770 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 no | yes | yes | no
2773 Arguments :
2774 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002775 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002776 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2777 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2778 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2779
2780 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2781 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2782 it exceeds <length>.
2783
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002784 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002785 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2786 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2787 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002788 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2789 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2790 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2791 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002792
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002793 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2794 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2795 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2796 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2797 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002798
2799 Example:
2800 capture response header Content-length len 9
2801 capture response header Location len 15
2802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002803 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804 about logging.
2805
2806
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002807clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2810 yes | yes | yes | no
2811 Arguments :
2812 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2814 as explained at the top of this document.
2815
2816 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2817 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2818 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2819 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2820 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2821 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2822 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2823 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002824 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002825 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2826 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2827
2828 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2829 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2830 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2831 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2832 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2833 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2834
2835 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2836 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2837
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002838 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2839 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002841compression algo <algorithm> ...
2842compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002843compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002844 Enable HTTP compression.
2845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2846 yes | yes | yes | yes
2847 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002848 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2849 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2850 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2851
2852 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002853 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2854 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2855 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002856
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002857 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002858 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002859
2860 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2861 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2862 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2863 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2864 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002865 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002866
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002867 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2868 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2869 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2870 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2871 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2872 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2873 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002874 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002875
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002876 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002877 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002878 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2879 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2880 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2881 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2882 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002883
2884 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2885 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2886 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2887 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2888 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002889 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2890 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2891 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2892 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2893 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002894 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2895 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002896
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002897 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002898 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2899 "Accept-Encoding" header
2900 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002901 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002902 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2903 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002904 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2905 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2906 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2907 "multipart"
2908 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2909 header
2910 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2911 and later
2912 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2913 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002914
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002915 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2916 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002917
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002918 Examples :
2919 compression algo gzip
2920 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002921
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002922
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002923contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2926 yes | no | yes | yes
2927 Arguments :
2928 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2930 as explained at the top of this document.
2931
2932 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002933 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002934 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2936 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2937 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2938 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2939
2940 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2941 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2942 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2943 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2944 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2945 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2946
2947 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2948 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2949 instead.
2950
2951 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2952 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2953
2954
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002955cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002956 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2957 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002958 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2961 yes | no | yes | yes
2962 Arguments :
2963 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2964 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2965 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2966 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2967 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2968 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2969 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2970 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2971 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2972
2973 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2974 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2975 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2976 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2977 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2978 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002979 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2980 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2981 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2982 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2983 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984
2985 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002986 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002987
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002988 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002989 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2990 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2991 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2992 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2993 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2994 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2995 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2996 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2997 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2998 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002999
3000 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3001 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3002 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3003 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3004 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3005 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3006 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3007 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3008 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003009 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003010 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3011 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3012 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003014 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3015 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3016 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003017 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3018 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3019 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3020 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003021 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3022 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3023 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024
3025 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3026 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3027 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3028 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3029 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3030 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3031 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3032 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3033 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3034
3035 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3036 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3037 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3038 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3039 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3040 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3041 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3042 persistence cookie in the cache.
3043 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3044
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003045 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3046 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3047 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3048 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3049 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
3050 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
3051 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3052 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3053 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3054 they logout.
3055
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003056 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3057 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3058 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3059 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3060
3061 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3062 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3063 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3064 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3065 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3066 this attribute.
3067
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003068 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003069 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003070 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3071 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3072 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3073 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3074 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3075 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003076
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003077 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3078 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3079 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3080 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3081 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3082 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3083 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3084 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3085 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
3086 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3087 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3088 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3089 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3090 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3091 the site.
3092
3093 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3094 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3095 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3096 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3097 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3098 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3099 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3100 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3101 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3102 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3103 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3104 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3105 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3106 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3107 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3108 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3109
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003110 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3111 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3112 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3113 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3114 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3115 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3118 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3119 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3120 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122 Examples :
3123 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3124 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3125 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003126 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003128 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003130
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003131declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3132 Declares a capture slot.
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 no | yes | yes | no
3135 Arguments:
3136 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3137
3138 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3139 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3140 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3141 for use in the response.
3142
3143 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003144 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003145 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3146
3147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003148default-server [param*]
3149 Change default options for a server in a backend
3150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3151 yes | no | yes | yes
3152 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003153 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3154 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3155 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3156 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003157
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003158 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003159 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3160
3161 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164default_backend <backend>
3165 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3167 yes | yes | yes | no
3168 Arguments :
3169 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3170
3171 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3172 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3173 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3174 will catch all undetermined requests.
3175
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176 Example :
3177
3178 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3179 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3180 default_backend dynamic
3181
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003182 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003185description <string>
3186 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 no | yes | yes | yes
3189 Arguments : string
3190
3191 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3192 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3193 it describes.
3194 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3195
3196
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003197disabled
3198 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3200 yes | yes | yes | yes
3201 Arguments : none
3202
3203 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3204 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3205 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3206 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3207 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3208 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3209 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3210
3211 See also : "enabled"
3212
3213
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003214dispatch <address>:<port>
3215 Set a default server address
3216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003219
3220 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3221 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3222 during start-up.
3223
3224 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3225 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3226 possible with normal servers.
3227
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003228 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003229 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3230 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3231 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3232 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3233
3234 See also : "server"
3235
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003236
3237dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3238 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 yes | no | yes | yes
3241 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3242
3243 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3244 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3245 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3246 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3247 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3248 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003250enabled
3251 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3253 yes | yes | yes | yes
3254 Arguments : none
3255
3256 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3257 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3258
3259 See also : "disabled"
3260
3261
3262errorfile <code> <file>
3263 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | yes | yes | yes
3266 Arguments :
3267 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003268 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3269 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
3271 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003272 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003274 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3275 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003276
3277 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3278 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3279 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3280
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003281 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3282
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003283 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3284 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3285 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3286 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3287
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003288 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3289 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3290 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3291 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3292 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3293 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3294
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003295 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3296 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3297 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003298 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003299 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3300
3301 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3302
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003303 Example :
3304 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003305 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003306 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3307 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3308
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003309
3310errorloc <code> <url>
3311errorloc302 <code> <url>
3312 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3314 yes | yes | yes | yes
3315 Arguments :
3316 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003317 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3318 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003319
3320 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3321 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3322 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3323 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3324 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3325
3326 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3327 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3328 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3329
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003330 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3331
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003332 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3333 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3334 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3335 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003336 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003337 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3338 request.
3339
3340 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3341
3342
3343errorloc303 <code> <url>
3344 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | yes | yes | yes
3347 Arguments :
3348 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003349 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3350 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003351
3352 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3353 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3354 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3355 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3356 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3357
3358 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3359 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3360 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3361
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003362 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3363
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003364 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3365 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3366 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3367 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003368 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003369
3370 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3371
3372
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003373email-alert from <emailaddr>
3374 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3375 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3376 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3377 yes | yes | yes | yes
3378
3379 Arguments :
3380
3381 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3382
3383 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3384 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3385
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003386 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003387 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3388 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003389
3390
3391email-alert level <level>
3392 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3393 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3394 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3395 yes | yes | yes | yes
3396
3397 Arguments :
3398
3399 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3400 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3401 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3402
3403 By default level is alert
3404
3405 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3406 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3407 for the proxy.
3408
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003409 Alerts are sent when :
3410
3411 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3412 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3413 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3414 is notice or lower
3415 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3416 and a health check status update occurs
3417
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003418 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3419 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003420 section 3.6 about mailers.
3421
3422
3423email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3424 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3426 yes | yes | yes | yes
3427
3428 Arguments :
3429
3430 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3431
3432 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3433 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3434
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003435 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3436 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003437
3438
3439email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3440 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3441 mailers.
3442 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3443 yes | yes | yes | yes
3444
3445 Arguments :
3446
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003447 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003448
3449 By default the systems hostname is used.
3450
3451 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3452 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3453 for the proxy.
3454
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003455 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3456 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003457
3458
3459email-alert to <emailaddr>
3460 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3461 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 yes | yes | yes | yes
3464
3465 Arguments :
3466
3467 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3468
3469 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3470 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3471
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003472 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003473 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3474
3475
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003476force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3477 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3478 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3479 no | yes | yes | yes
3480
3481 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3482 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3483 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3484 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3485 marked down for maintenance operations.
3486
3487 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3488 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3489 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3490 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3491 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3492 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3493 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3494 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3495 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3496
3497 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3498 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3499 is used.
3500
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003501 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003502 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003503
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003504
3505filter <name> [param*]
3506 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3508 no | yes | yes | yes
3509 Arguments :
3510 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3511 referenced in section 9.
3512
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003513 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003514 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003515 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3516 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003517
3518 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3519 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3520
3521 Example:
3522 listen
3523 bind *:80
3524
3525 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3526 filter compression
3527 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3528
3529 compression algo gzip
3530 compression offload
3531
3532 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3533
3534 See also : section 9.
3535
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003536
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003537fullconn <conns>
3538 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | no | yes | yes
3541 Arguments :
3542 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3543 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3544
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003545 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003546 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003547 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003548 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3549 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3550 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3551 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3552 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003553 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003554
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003555 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3556 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003557 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3558 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3559 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003561 Example :
3562 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3563 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3564 # connections.
3565 backend dynamic
3566 fullconn 10000
3567 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3568 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3569
3570 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3571
3572
3573grace <time>
3574 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003576 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003577 Arguments :
3578 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3579 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3580 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3581
3582 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3583 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003584 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3586
3587 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3588 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3589 simplify it.
3590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003591
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003592hash-balance-factor <factor>
3593 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | no | no | yes
3596 Arguments :
3597 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3598 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3599 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3600
3601 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3602 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3603 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3604 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3605 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3606 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3607 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3608
3609 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3610 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3611 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3612 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3613 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3614
3615 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3616
3617
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003618hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003619 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3621 yes | no | yes | yes
3622 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003623 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3624 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003625
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003626 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3627 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3628 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3629 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3630 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3631 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3632 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3633 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3634 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3635 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003636
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003637 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3638 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3639 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3640 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3641 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3642 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3643 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3644 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3645 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3646 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3647 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3648 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3649 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003650 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3651 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003652
3653 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3654
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003655 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003656 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3657 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3658 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003659 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3660 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3661 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003662
3663 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3664 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003665 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3666 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3667 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3668 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3669
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003670 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3671 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3672 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3673 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3674 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3675 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3676 parameter.
3677
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003678 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3679 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3680 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3681 used on strings.
3682
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003683 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3684
3685 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3686 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3687 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3688 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3689 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3690 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3691 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3692 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3693 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3694 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3695 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3696 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003697
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003698 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3699 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3700 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003701
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003702 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003703
3704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003705http-check disable-on-404
3706 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003708 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003709 Arguments : none
3710
3711 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3712 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3713 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3714 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3715 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3716 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3717 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3718 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003719 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3720 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3721 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3722
3723 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3724
3725
3726http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003727 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003729 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003730 Arguments :
3731 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3732 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003733 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003734 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3735 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3736 details on the supported keywords.
3737
3738 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3739 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3740 with the usual backslash ('\').
3741
3742 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3743 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3744 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3745 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3746 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3747
3748 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003749 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003750 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3751 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3752 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3753
3754 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003755 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003756 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3757 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3758 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3759 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3760
3761 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003762 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003763 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3764 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3765 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3766 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3767 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3768 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3769 trace).
3770
3771 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003772 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003773 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3774 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3775 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3776 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3777 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3778 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3779
3780 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3781 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3782 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3783 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3784 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3785 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3786 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3787 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3788
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003789 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3790 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3791 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3792
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003793 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3794 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3795
3796 Examples :
3797 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003798 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003799
3800 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003801 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003802
3803 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003804 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003805
3806 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003807 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003809 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003810
3811
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003812http-check send-state
3813 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3815 yes | no | yes | yes
3816 Arguments : none
3817
3818 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3819 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3820 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3821 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3822 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3823
3824 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3825 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3826 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3827 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3828 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003829 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3830 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3831 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3832
3833 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3834 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3835 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3836
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003837 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3838 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3839 checked in multiple backends.
3840
3841 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3842 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3843
3844 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3845 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3846 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3847 one fails.
3848
3849 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3850 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3851 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3852
3853 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3854 server's queue.
3855
3856 Example of a header received by the application server :
3857 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3858 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3859
3860 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3861
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003862http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003863 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003864 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003865 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003866 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003867 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3868 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003869 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3870 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003871 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3872 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3873 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003874 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003875 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003876 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003877 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003878 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003879 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003880 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01003881 send-spoe-group |
3882 cache-use
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003883 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003884 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003885 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3886
3887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3888 no | yes | yes | yes
3889
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003890 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3891 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3892 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3893 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3894 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003895
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003896 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3897 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3898 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3899
3900 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003901 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3902 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3903 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3904 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003905
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003906 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3907 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3908 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3909 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3910
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003911 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3912 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3913 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003914 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3915 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003916 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3917 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3918 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3919 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3920 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003921 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003922 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3923 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003924
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003925 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3926 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3927 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3928 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3929 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3930
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003931 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3932 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3933 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003934 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3935 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003936
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003937 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3938 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3939 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3940 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3941 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3942 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3943 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3944 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3945
3946 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3947 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3948 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003949 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3950 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003951
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003952 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3953 <name>.
3954
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003955 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3956 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3957 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3958 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3959 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3960 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3961 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3962 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3963
3964 Example:
3965
3966 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3967
3968 applied to:
3969
3970 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3971
3972 outputs:
3973
3974 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3975
3976 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3977
3978 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3979 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3980 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3981 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3982 header.
3983
3984 Example:
3985
3986 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3987
3988 applied to:
3989
3990 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3991
3992 outputs:
3993
3994 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3995
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003996 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3997 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3998 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3999 it.
4000
4001 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4002 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4003 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4004 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4005 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4006 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4007
4008 Example :
4009 # prepend the host name before the path
4010 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4011
4012 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4013 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4014 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4015 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4016 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4017 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4018 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4019 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4020
4021 Example :
4022 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4023 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4024
4025 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4026 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4027 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4028 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4029 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4030 "set-query".
4031
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004032 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4033 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4034 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4035 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4036 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4037 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4038 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4039 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4040
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004041 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4042 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4043 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4044 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4045 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4046 another equipment.
4047
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004048 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4049 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4050 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4051 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4052 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4053 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4054 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4055 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4056
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004057 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4058 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4059 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4060 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4061 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4062 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4063 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4064 admin privileges.
4065
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004066 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4067 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4068 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4069 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4070 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4071 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4072 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4073 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4074
4075 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4076 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4077 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4078 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4079 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4080 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4081
4082 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4083 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4084 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4085 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4086 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4087 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4088
4089 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4090 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4091 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4092 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4093 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4094 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4095 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4096 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4097 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4098
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004099 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004100 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4101 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4102 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4103 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4104 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4105 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4106 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4107 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4108 request header" for more information.
4109
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004110 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4111 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4112 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4113 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004114 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4115 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004116
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004117 - cache-use <name> :
4118 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4119
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004120 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4121 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4122 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4123 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4124 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4125 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4126 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4127 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4128 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4129 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4130 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4131 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4132
4133 These actions take one or two arguments :
4134 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4135 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4136 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4137 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4138
4139 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4140 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4141 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4142 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4143
4144 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4145 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4146 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4147 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4148 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4149 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4150 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4151 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4152
4153 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4154 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4155 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4156 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4157 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4158
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004159 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4160 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4161 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4162 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4163 continues.
4164
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004165 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4166 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4167 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4168 the actions evaluation continues.
4169
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004170 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4171 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4172 inline.
4173
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004174 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4175 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004176 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004177 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4178 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004179 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004180 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004181 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004182 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4183 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004184 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004185 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004186 and '_'.
4187
4188 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4189 followed by some converters.
4190
4191 Example:
4192
4193 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4194
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004195 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4196 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4197
4198 Example:
4199
4200 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4201
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004202 - set-src <expr> :
4203 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4204 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4205 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4206 source IP for privacy.
4207
4208 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4209 followed by some converters.
4210
4211 Example:
4212
4213 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4214 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4215
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004216 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4217 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004218
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004219 - set-src-port <expr> :
4220 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4221 expression.
4222
4223 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4224 followed by some converters.
4225
4226 Example:
4227
4228 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4229 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4230
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004231 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4232 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4233 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004234
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004235 - set-dst <expr> :
4236 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4237 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4238 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4239 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4240 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4241
4242 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4243 followed by some converters.
4244
4245 Example:
4246
4247 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4248 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4249
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004250 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4251 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4252
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004253 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4254 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4255 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4256 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4257
4258 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4259 followed by some converters.
4260
4261 Example:
4262
4263 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4264 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4265
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004266 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4267 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4268 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4269
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004270 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4271 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4272 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4273 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4274 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4275 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4276 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4277 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4278 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4279 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4280 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4281 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4282 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4283 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4284 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4285 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4286
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004287
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004288 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4289 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4290 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4291
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004292 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4293 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4294 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4295 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4296 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4297 SPOE agent name must be used.
4298
4299 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4300
4301 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4302 configuration.
4303
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004304 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4305
4306 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4307 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004308 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4309 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4310
4311 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4312 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4313 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4314 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004315
4316 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004317 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4318 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4319 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004320
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004321 http-request allow if nagios
4322 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4323 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4324 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004325
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004326 Example:
4327 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004328 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004329
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004330 Example:
4331 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4332 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004333 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004334 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4335 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4336 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4337 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4338 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4339 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4340
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004341 Example:
4342 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4343 acl add path /addacl
4344 acl del path /delacl
4345
4346 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4347
4348 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4349 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4350
4351 Example:
4352 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4353 acl setmap path /setmap
4354 acl delmap path /delmap
4355
4356 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4357
4358 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4359 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4360
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004361 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4362 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004363
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004364http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004365 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004366 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004367 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4368 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004369 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004370 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4371 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4372 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4373 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004374 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004375 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004376 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004377 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004378 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004379 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004380 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004381 send-spoe-group |
4382 cache-store
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004383 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004385 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4386
4387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4388 no | yes | yes | yes
4389
4390 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4391 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4392 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4393 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4394 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4395 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4396
4397 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4398 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4399 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4400 current section.
4401
4402 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4403 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4404 rules are evaluated.
4405
4406 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4407 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4408 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4409 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4410 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4411 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4412 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4413
4414 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4415 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4416 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4417 external users.
4418
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004419 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4420 <name>.
4421
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004422 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4423 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4424 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4425 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4426 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4427 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4428 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4429 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4430
4431 Example:
4432
4433 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4434
4435 applied to:
4436
4437 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4438
4439 outputs:
4440
4441 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4442
4443 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4444
4445 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4446 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4447 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4448 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4449 header.
4450
4451 Example:
4452
4453 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4454
4455 applied to:
4456
4457 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4458
4459 outputs:
4460
4461 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4462
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004463 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004464 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4465 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4466 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004467
4468 Example:
4469
4470 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4471 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004472 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4473 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004474
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004475 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4476 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4477 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4478 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4479 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4480 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4481 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4482 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4483
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004484 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4485 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4486 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4487 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4488 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4489 another equipment.
4490
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004491 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4492 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4493 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4494 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4495 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4496 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4497 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4498 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4499
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004500 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4501 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4502 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4503 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4504 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4505 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4506 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4507 admin privileges.
4508
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004509 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4510 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4511 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4512 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4513 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4514 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4515 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4516 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4517
4518 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4519 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4520 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4521 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4522 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4523 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4524
4525 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4526 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4527 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4528 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4529 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4530 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4531
4532 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4533 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4534 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4535 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4536 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4537 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4538 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4539 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4540 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4541
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004542 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4543 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4544 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4545 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4546 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4547 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4548 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4549 response header" for more information.
4550
4551 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4552 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4553 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4554 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4555 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004556 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4557 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004558
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004559 - cache-store <name> :
4560 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4561
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004562 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4563 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4564 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4565 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4566 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4567 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4568
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004569 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4570 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4571 inline.
4572
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004573 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4574 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004575 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004576 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4577 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004578 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004579 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004580 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004581 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4582 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004583 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004584 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4585 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004586
4587 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4588 followed by some converters.
4589
4590 Example:
4591
4592 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4593
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004594 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4595 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4596
4597 Example:
4598
4599 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4600
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004601 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4602 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4603 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4604 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4605 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4606 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4607 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4608
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004609 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4610 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4611 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4612 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4613 continues.
4614
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004615 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4616 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4617 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4618 the actions evaluation continues.
4619
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004620 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4621 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4622 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4623 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4624 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4625 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4626 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4627 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4628 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4629 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4630 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4631 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4632 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4633 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4634 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4635 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4636
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004637 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4638 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4639 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4640 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4641 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4642 SPOE agent name must be used.
4643
4644 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4645
4646 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4647 configuration.
4648
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004649 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4650
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004651 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004652 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4653 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004654 rules.
4655
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004656 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4657 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4658 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4659 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4660
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004661 Example:
4662 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4663
4664 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4665
4666 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4667 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4668
4669 Example:
4670 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4671
4672 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4673
4674 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4675 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4676
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004677 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4678 ACL usage.
4679
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004680
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004681http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4682 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4683
4684 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4685 yes | no | yes | yes
4686
4687 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4688 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4689 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4690 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4691 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4692 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4693
4694 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4695
4696 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4697 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4698 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4699 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4700 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4701 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4702 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4703 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4704 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4705 not checking any request past the first one.
4706
4707 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4708 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4709 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4710 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4711 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4712 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4713 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4714
4715 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4716 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4717 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4718 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4719 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4720 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4721 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4722 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4723 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4724 downsides of rare connection failures.
4725
4726 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4727 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4728 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4729 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4730 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4731 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4732 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4733 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4734 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4735 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4736 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4737 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4738
4739 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4740 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4741 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4742 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4743
4744 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4745 and are never shared ;
4746
4747 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4748 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4749 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4750 and are never shared ;
4751
4752 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4753 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4754 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4755
4756 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4757 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4758 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4759
4760 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4761
4762
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004763http-send-name-header [<header>]
4764 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4765
4766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4767 yes | no | yes | yes
4768
4769 Arguments :
4770
4771 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4772
4773 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4774 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4775 is added with the header string proved.
4776
4777 See also : "server"
4778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004779id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004780 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4782 no | yes | yes | yes
4783 Arguments : none
4784
4785 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4786 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4787 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004788
4789
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004790ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4791 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 no | yes | yes | yes
4794
4795 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4796 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4797 and running).
4798
4799 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4800 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4801 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004802 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004803 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4804
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004805 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4806 "unless" condition is met.
4807
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004808 Example:
4809 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4810 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4811 ignore-persist if url_static
4812
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004813 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4814
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004815load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4816 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4818 yes | no | yes | yes
4819
4820 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4821 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4822 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4823 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4824 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4825 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4826 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4827 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4828
4829 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4830 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004831 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004832
4833 Arguments:
4834 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4835 named "server-state-file".
4836
4837 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4838 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4839 name is used as a file name.
4840
4841 none don't load any stat for this backend
4842
4843 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004844 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4845 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4846 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4847 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4848 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004849
4850 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4851 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4852
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004853 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004854
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004855 global
4856 stats socket /tmp/socket
4857 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004858
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004859 defaults
4860 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004861
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004862 backend bk
4863 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4864 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004865
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004866
4867 Then one can run :
4868
4869 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4870
4871 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4872
4873 1
4874 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4875 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4876 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4877
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004878 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004879
4880 global
4881 stats socket /tmp/socket
4882 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4883
4884 defaults
4885 load-server-state-from-file local
4886
4887 backend bk
4888 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4889 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4890
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004891
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004892 Then one can run :
4893
4894 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4895
4896 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4897
4898 1
4899 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4900 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4901 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4902
4903 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4904 "show servers state"
4905
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004906
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004907log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004908log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004909no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4912 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004913
4914 Prefix :
4915 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4916 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4917 prefix does not allow arguments.
4918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919 Arguments :
4920 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4921 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4922 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4923 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4924 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4925 parameter.
4926
4927 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4928 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4929
4930 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4931 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4932 standard syslog port).
4933
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004934 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4935 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4936 standard syslog port).
4937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4939 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4940 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4941 appropriately writeable).
4942
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004943 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4944 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004945
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004946 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4947 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4948 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4949 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4950 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4951 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4952 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4953 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4954 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4955 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4956 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4957
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004958 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4959
4960 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4961 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4962 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4963
4964 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4965 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4966 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004967 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4968 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4969 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4970 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4971 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004972
4973 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4974
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004975 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4976 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4977 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004978
4979 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4980 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4981 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4982 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4983
4984 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4985 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004986
4987 Example :
4988 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004989 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4990 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004991 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004992
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004993
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004994log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004995 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004998
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004999 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5000 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5001 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5002 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5003 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005004
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005005 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5006 "option httplog" directives.
5007
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005008log-format-sd <string>
5009 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5011 yes | yes | yes | no
5012
5013 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5014 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5015 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5016 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5017 which covers the log format string in depth.
5018
5019 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5020 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5021
5022 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5023 log format to "rfc5424".
5024
5025 Example :
5026 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5027
5028
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005029log-tag <string>
5030 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 yes | yes | yes | yes
5033
5034 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5035 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5036 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5037 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5038 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5039 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5040 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5041 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5042 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005043
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005044max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5045 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5046 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5047 yes | no | yes | yes
5048
5049 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5050 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5051 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5052 servers.
5053
5054 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5055 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5056 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5057 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5058 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
5059 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
5060 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5061 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5062 picking a different server.
5063
5064 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5065 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5066 even if they have to be queued.
5067
5068 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5069 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5070
5071
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005072maxconn <conns>
5073 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | yes | yes | no
5076 Arguments :
5077 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5078 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5079 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5080 closes.
5081
5082 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5083 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5084 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5085 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005086 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5087 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5088 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5089 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005090
5091 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5092 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5093 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5094
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005095 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5096
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005097 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5098
5099
5100mode { tcp|http|health }
5101 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5103 yes | yes | yes | yes
5104 Arguments :
5105 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5106 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5107 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5108 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5109
5110 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5111 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5112 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5113 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5114 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5115
5116 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005117 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5118 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5119 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5120 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5121 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5122 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5123 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005124
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005125 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5126 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5127 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005129 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005130 defaults http_instances
5131 mode http
5132
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005133 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005135
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005136monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005137 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5139 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005140 Arguments :
5141 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5142 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005143 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005144 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5145 backend and its backup.
5146
5147 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5148 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5149 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5150 servers in a list of backends.
5151
5152 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5153 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5154 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5155 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5156 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5157 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5158 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005159 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5160 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005161
5162 Example:
5163 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005164 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005165 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5166 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5167 monitor-uri /site_alive
5168 monitor fail if site_dead
5169
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005170 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005171
5172
5173monitor-net <source>
5174 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | yes | yes | no
5177 Arguments :
5178 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5179 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5180 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5181 followed by a mask.
5182
5183 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5184 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005185 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005186 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5187
5188 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5189 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5190 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5191 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005192 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5193 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5194 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005195
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005196 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5197 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5198 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5199 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5200 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5201 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005202
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005203 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5204 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005205
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005206 Example :
5207 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5208 frontend www
5209 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5210
5211 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5212
5213
5214monitor-uri <uri>
5215 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5217 yes | yes | yes | no
5218 Arguments :
5219 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5220 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5221
5222 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5223 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5224 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5225 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5226 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5227 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5228 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5229 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5230
5231 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5232 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5233 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5234 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5235 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5236 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5237
5238 Example :
5239 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5240 frontend www
5241 mode http
5242 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5243
5244 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005246
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005247option abortonclose
5248no option abortonclose
5249 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5251 yes | no | yes | yes
5252 Arguments : none
5253
5254 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5255 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5256 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5257 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005258 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005259 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5260 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5261 encountered while delivering the response.
5262
5263 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5264 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5265 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5266 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5267 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5268 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005269 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005270 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005271 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005272 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5273 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5274 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5275
5276 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5277 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5278 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5279 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5280 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5281 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5282 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5283 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005284 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005285
5286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5288
5289 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5290
5291
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005292option accept-invalid-http-request
5293no option accept-invalid-http-request
5294 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | yes | yes | no
5297 Arguments : none
5298
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005299 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005300 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5301 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5302 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5303 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5304 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5305 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5306 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005307 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5308 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5309 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5310 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5311 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005312 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005313 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5314 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5315 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005316
5317 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5318 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5319 been confirmed.
5320
5321 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5322 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005323 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5324 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005325 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5326
5327 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5328 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5329
5330 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5331 stats socket.
5332
5333
5334option accept-invalid-http-response
5335no option accept-invalid-http-response
5336 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 yes | no | yes | yes
5339 Arguments : none
5340
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005341 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005342 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5343 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5344 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5345 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5346 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5347 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5348 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005349 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5350 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5351 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005352
5353 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5354 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5355 been confirmed.
5356
5357 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5358 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5359 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5360 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5361
5362 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5363 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5364
5365 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5366 stats socket.
5367
5368
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005369option allbackups
5370no option allbackups
5371 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5373 yes | no | yes | yes
5374 Arguments : none
5375
5376 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5377 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5378 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5379 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5380 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5381 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5382 order between the backup servers anymore.
5383
5384 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5385 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5386
5387 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5388 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5389
5390
5391option checkcache
5392no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005393 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5395 yes | no | yes | yes
5396 Arguments : none
5397
5398 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5399 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005400 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005401 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5402 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005403 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005404
5405 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005406 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005407 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005408 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5409 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005410 to the client are :
5411 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005412 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005413 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005414 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5415 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5416 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5417 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5418 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5419 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5420 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5421 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5422 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5423 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5424 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5425
5426 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005427 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005428 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005429 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005430 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5431
5432 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5433 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005434 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005435 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5436
5437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5439
5440
5441option clitcpka
5442no option clitcpka
5443 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | yes | yes | no
5446 Arguments : none
5447
5448 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5449 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5450 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5451 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5452
5453 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5454 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5455 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5456 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5457
5458 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5459 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5460 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5461 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5462 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5463
5464 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5465
5466 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5467 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5468 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5469
5470 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5471 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5472
5473 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5474
5475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005476option contstats
5477 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5479 yes | yes | yes | no
5480 Arguments : none
5481
5482 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5483 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5484 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5485 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005486 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5487 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5488 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5489 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5490 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005491
5492
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005493option dontlog-normal
5494no option dontlog-normal
5495 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5497 yes | yes | yes | no
5498 Arguments : none
5499
5500 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5501 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5502 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5503 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5504 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5505 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5506 logged.
5507
5508 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5509 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5510 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005512 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005513 logging.
5514
5515
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005516option dontlognull
5517no option dontlognull
5518 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5520 yes | yes | yes | no
5521 Arguments : none
5522
5523 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5524 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5525 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5526 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5527 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5528 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005529 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5530 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5531 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005532
5533 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5534 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5535 would not be logged.
5536
5537 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5538 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5539
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005540 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5541 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005542
5543
5544option forceclose
5545no option forceclose
5546 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005548 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005549 Arguments : none
5550
5551 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5552 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5553 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5554 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5555 global session times in the logs.
5556
5557 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005558 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005559 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005560
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005561 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5562 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5563 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5564
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005565 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5566 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005567
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005568 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5569 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5570
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005571 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005572
5573
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005574option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005575 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5577 yes | yes | yes | yes
5578 Arguments :
5579 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5580 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005581 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005582 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005583
5584 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5585 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5586 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5587 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5588 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5589 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5590 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005591 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5592 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5593 possible that the client has already brought one.
5594
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005595 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005596 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005597 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5598 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005599 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5600 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005601
5602 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5603 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5604 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5605 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5606 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5607 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5608 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5609
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005610 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5611 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5612 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5613 are under the control of the end-user.
5614
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005615 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005616 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5617 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005618 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5619 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5620 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005621
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005622 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005623 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5624 frontend www
5625 mode http
5626 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5627
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005628 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5629 backend www
5630 mode http
5631 option forwardfor header X-Client
5632
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005633 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005634 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005635
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005636
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005637option http-buffer-request
5638no option http-buffer-request
5639 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5641 yes | yes | yes | yes
5642 Arguments : none
5643
5644 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5645 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5646 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5647 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5648 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5649 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5650 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5651 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005652 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005653 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5654 default.
5655
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005656 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005657
5658
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005659option http-ignore-probes
5660no option http-ignore-probes
5661 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 yes | yes | yes | no
5664 Arguments : none
5665
5666 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5667 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5668 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5669 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5670 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5671 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5672 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5673 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5674 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5675 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5676 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5677 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5678
5679 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5680 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5681 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5682 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5683 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5684 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5685 are often the only way to detect them.
5686
5687 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5688 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5689
5690 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5691
5692
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005693option http-keep-alive
5694no option http-keep-alive
5695 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5697 yes | yes | yes | yes
5698 Arguments : none
5699
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005700 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5701 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5702 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5703 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5704 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5705 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5706 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5707
5708 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5709 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005710 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5711 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5712 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5713 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5714 situations where this option may be useful :
5715
5716 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5717 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5718
5719 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5720 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5721
5722 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5723 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5724 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5725 request.
5726
5727 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5728 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005729 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5730 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5731 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005732
5733 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5734 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5735
5736 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5737 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5738 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5739 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5740 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5741 not set.
5742
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005743 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5744 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005745 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005746 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005747
5748 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005749 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5750 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005751
5752
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005753option http-no-delay
5754no option http-no-delay
5755 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5757 yes | yes | yes | yes
5758 Arguments : none
5759
5760 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5761 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5762 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5763 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5764 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5765 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5766 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5767 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5768 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5769 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5770 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5771 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5772 affected.
5773
5774 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5775 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5776 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5777 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5778 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5779 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5780 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5781 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5782 latency environments.
5783
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005784 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5785
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005786
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005787option http-pretend-keepalive
5788no option http-pretend-keepalive
5789 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5791 yes | yes | yes | yes
5792 Arguments : none
5793
5794 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5795 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5796 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5797 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5798 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5799 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5800 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5801 consider the response complete.
5802
5803 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5804 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5805 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5806 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5807 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5808 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5809
5810 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5811 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5812 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5813 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5814 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5815 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5816 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5817
5818 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5819 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005820 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005821 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5822 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005823
5824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5826
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005827 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5828 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005829
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005830
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005831option http-server-close
5832no option http-server-close
5833 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5835 yes | yes | yes | yes
5836 Arguments : none
5837
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005838 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5839 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5840 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5841 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5842 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5843 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5844 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5845 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5846 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5847 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5848 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005849 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005850 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5851 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5852 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5853 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005854
5855 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5856 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5857 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5858 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005859 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5860 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005861
5862 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5863 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005864 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5865 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005866 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5867 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005868
5869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5871
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005872 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005873 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5874 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005875
5876
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005877option http-tunnel
5878no option http-tunnel
5879 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5881 yes | yes | yes | yes
5882 Arguments : none
5883
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005884 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5885 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5886 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5887 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5888 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5889 "option http-tunnel".
5890
5891 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005892 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005893 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5894 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5895 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5896 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5897 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5898 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5899 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005900
5901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5903
5904 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5905 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5906 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5907
5908
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005909option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005910no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005911 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5913 yes | yes | yes | no
5914 Arguments : none
5915
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005916 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005917 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5918 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5919 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5920 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5921 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5922 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5923
5924 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5925 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005926 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5927 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5928 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005929
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005930 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5931 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5932 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5933 front of an existing proxy.
5934
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005935 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5936
5937 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5938 http-server-close".
5939
5940
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005941option httpchk
5942option httpchk <uri>
5943option httpchk <method> <uri>
5944option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5945 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5947 yes | no | yes | yes
5948 Arguments :
5949 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5950 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5951 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5952 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5953 ones.
5954
5955 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5956 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5957 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5958
5959 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5960 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5961 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5962 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5963 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5964
5965 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5966 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5967 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5968 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5969 the lack of any response.
5970
5971 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5972
5973 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5974 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5975 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5976
5977 Examples :
5978 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5979 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5980 backend https_relay
5981 mode tcp
5982 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5983 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5984
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005985 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5986 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5987 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005988
5989
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005990option httpclose
5991no option httpclose
5992 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | yes | yes | yes
5995 Arguments : none
5996
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005997 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5998 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5999 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6000 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006001 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006002 "option http-tunnel".
6003
6004 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
6005 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
6006 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
6007 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
6008 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
6009 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
6010 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
6011 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006012
6013 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006014 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01006015 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
6016 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
6017 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
6018 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
6019 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006020
6021 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6022 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006023 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
6024 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006025 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
6026 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006027
6028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6030
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02006031 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
6032 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006033
6034
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006035option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006036 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006039 Arguments :
6040 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6041 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6042 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
6043 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
6044 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006045
6046 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6047 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6048 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6049 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6050 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6051 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6052 ports.
6053
6054 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6055
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006056 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6057 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006058
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006059 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006061 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006062
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006063
6064option http_proxy
6065no option http_proxy
6066 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6068 yes | yes | yes | yes
6069 Arguments : none
6070
6071 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6072 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6073 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6074 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6075 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6076
6077 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6078 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006079 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6080 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006081
6082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6084
6085 Example :
6086 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6087 backend direct_forward
6088 option httpclose
6089 option http_proxy
6090
6091 See also : "option httpclose"
6092
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006093
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006094option independent-streams
6095no option independent-streams
6096 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6098 yes | yes | yes | yes
6099 Arguments : none
6100
6101 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6102 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6103 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6104 receive data or not.
6105
6106 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6107 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6108 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6109 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6110 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6111 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6112 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6113 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6114 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6115 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6116 socket buffers.
6117
6118 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6119 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6120 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6121 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6122 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6123
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006124 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006125 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6126 deprecated.
6127
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006128 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006129
6130
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006131option ldap-check
6132 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6134 yes | no | yes | yes
6135 Arguments : none
6136
6137 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6138 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6139 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6140 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6141
6142 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6143 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6144
6145 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6146 configure it.
6147
6148 Example :
6149 option ldap-check
6150
6151 See also : "option httpchk"
6152
6153
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006154option external-check
6155 Use external processes for server health checks
6156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 yes | no | yes | yes
6158
6159 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6160 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6161 command".
6162
6163 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6164
6165 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6166
6167
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006168option log-health-checks
6169no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006170 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6172 yes | no | yes | yes
6173 Arguments : none
6174
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006175 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6176 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6177 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006178
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006179 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6180 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6181 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6182 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6183 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6184
6185 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6186 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006187
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006188 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6189 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6190 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006191
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006192
6193option log-separate-errors
6194no option log-separate-errors
6195 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 yes | yes | yes | no
6198 Arguments : none
6199
6200 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6201 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6202 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6203 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6204 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6205 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6206 provides very important information.
6207
6208 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6209 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6210 error logs.
6211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006212 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006213 logging.
6214
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006215
6216option logasap
6217no option logasap
6218 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 yes | yes | yes | no
6221 Arguments : none
6222
6223 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6224 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6225 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6226 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6227 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6228 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6229 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006230 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006231 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6232 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6233
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006234 Examples :
6235 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6236 mode http
6237 option httplog
6238 option logasap
6239 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6240
6241 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6242 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6243 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6244 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6245
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006246 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006247 logging.
6248
6249
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006250option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006251 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6253 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006254 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006255 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6256 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006257 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006258
6259 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6260 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6261 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6262 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6263 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6264 in the MySQL table, like this :
6265
6266 USE mysql;
6267 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6268 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6269
6270 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6271 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6272 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6273 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6274 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6275 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6276 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6277 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6278 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6279
6280 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6281 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006282
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006283 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006284
6285 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6286 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6287 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6288 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006289 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6290 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006291
6292 See also: "option httpchk"
6293
6294
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006295option nolinger
6296no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006297 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006298 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006300 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006301
6302 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6303 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6304 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6305 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6306 connections.
6307
6308 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6309 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6310 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6311 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6312 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6313 this too.
6314
6315 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6316 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6317 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6318
6319 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6320 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6321 for servers.
6322
6323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6325
6326
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006327option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6328 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6330 yes | yes | yes | yes
6331 Arguments :
6332 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6333 matching <network>
6334 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6335 header name.
6336
6337 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6338 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6339 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6340 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6341 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6342 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6343 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6344 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6345 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6346 possible that the client has already brought one.
6347
6348 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6349 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6350 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6351 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6352 header and requires different one.
6353
6354 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6355 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6356 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6357 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6358 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6359 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6360 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6361
6362 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6363 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6364 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6365 both are defined.
6366
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006367 Examples :
6368 # Original Destination address
6369 frontend www
6370 mode http
6371 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6372
6373 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6374 backend www
6375 mode http
6376 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6377
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006378 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6379 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006380
6381
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006382option persist
6383no option persist
6384 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6386 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006387 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006388
6389 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6390 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6391 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6392 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6393 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6394 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6395 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6396 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6397 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6398 redirected to another valid server.
6399
6400 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6401 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6402
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006403 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006404
6405
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006406option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6407 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6409 yes | no | yes | yes
6410 Arguments :
6411 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6412 PostgreSQL server.
6413
6414 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6415 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6416 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6417 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6418
6419 See also: "option httpchk"
6420
6421
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006422option prefer-last-server
6423no option prefer-last-server
6424 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6426 yes | no | yes | yes
6427 Arguments : none
6428
6429 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6430 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6431 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6432 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6433 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6434 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6435 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6436 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6437 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006438 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6439 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6440 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6441 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6442 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6443 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6444 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006445
6446 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6447 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6448
6449 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6450
6451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006452option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006453option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006454no option redispatch
6455 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006458 Arguments :
6459 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6460 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6461 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6462 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6463 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6464 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6465 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6466 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6467 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6468
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006469
6470 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6471 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6472 be able to access the service anymore.
6473
6474 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6475 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6476
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006477 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006478 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6479 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006481 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6482 "redisp" keywords.
6483
6484 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6485 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6486
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006487 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006488
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006489
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006490option redis-check
6491 Use redis health checks for server testing
6492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 yes | no | yes | yes
6494 Arguments : none
6495
6496 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6497 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6498 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6499 find the "+PONG" response message.
6500
6501 Example :
6502 option redis-check
6503
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006504 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006505
6506
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006507option smtpchk
6508option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6509 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6511 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006512 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006513 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6514 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6515 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6516
6517 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6518 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6519 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6520
6521 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6522 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6523 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6524 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6525 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6526 dead server.
6527
6528 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6529 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6530 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6531 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6532
6533 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6534 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6535 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6536 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006537 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006538
6539 Example :
6540 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6541
6542 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6543
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006545option socket-stats
6546no option socket-stats
6547
6548 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6550 yes | yes | yes | no
6551
6552 Arguments : none
6553
6554
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006555option splice-auto
6556no option splice-auto
6557 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 yes | yes | yes | yes
6560 Arguments : none
6561
6562 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6563 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6564 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6565 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006566 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006567 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6568 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6569 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6570 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6571
6572 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6573 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6574 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6575 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6576 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6577 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6578 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6579 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6580 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6581 keyword.
6582
6583 Example :
6584 option splice-auto
6585
6586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6588
6589 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6590 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6591
6592
6593option splice-request
6594no option splice-request
6595 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 yes | yes | yes | yes
6598 Arguments : none
6599
6600 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006601 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006602 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6603 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6604 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6605 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6606
6607 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6608
6609 Example :
6610 option splice-request
6611
6612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6614
6615 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6616 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6617
6618
6619option splice-response
6620no option splice-response
6621 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 yes | yes | yes | yes
6624 Arguments : none
6625
6626 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006627 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006628 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6629 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6630 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6631 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6632
6633 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6634
6635 Example :
6636 option splice-response
6637
6638 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6639 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6640
6641 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6642 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6643
6644
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006645option spop-check
6646 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6648 no | no | no | yes
6649 Arguments : none
6650
6651 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6652 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6653 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6654 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6655
6656 Example :
6657 option spop-check
6658
6659 See also : "option httpchk"
6660
6661
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006662option srvtcpka
6663no option srvtcpka
6664 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6666 yes | no | yes | yes
6667 Arguments : none
6668
6669 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6670 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6671 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6672 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6673
6674 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6675 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6676 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6677 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6678
6679 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6680 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6681 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6682 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6683 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6684
6685 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6686
6687 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6688 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6689 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6690
6691 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6692 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6693
6694 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6695
6696
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006697option ssl-hello-chk
6698 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6700 yes | no | yes | yes
6701 Arguments : none
6702
6703 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6704 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6705 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6706 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6707 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6708 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6709 hello message.
6710
6711 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6712 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6713 messages, which is appreciable.
6714
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006715 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6716 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6717 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006718
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006719 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6720
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006721
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006722option tcp-check
6723 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6724 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6725 yes | no | yes | yes
6726
6727 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6728 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6729
6730 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6731 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6732 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6733
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006734 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006735 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6736 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6737 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6738 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6739 only.
6740
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006741 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006742 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6743 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6744 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6745 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6746
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006747 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006748 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6749 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006750 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006751 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6752 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6753 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6754 the respective protocols.
6755 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6756 analysed.
6757
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006758 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6759 script.
6760
6761 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6762 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6763 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6764 The "comment" is of course optional.
6765
6766
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006767 Examples :
6768 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6769 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006770 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006771
6772 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6773 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006774 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006775
6776 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6777 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006778 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006779 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006780 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006781 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006782 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006783 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006784 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6785 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006786 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006787 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6788 tcp-check expect string +OK
6789
6790 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6791 (send many headers before analyzing)
6792 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006793 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006794 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6795 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6796 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6797 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006798 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006799
6800
6801 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6802
6803
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006804option tcp-smart-accept
6805no option tcp-smart-accept
6806 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6808 yes | yes | yes | no
6809 Arguments : none
6810
6811 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6812 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6813 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6814 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6815 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6816 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6817
6818 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6819 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6820 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6821 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6822
6823 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6824 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6825 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6826 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6827
6828 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6829 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6830 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6831
6832 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6833 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6834 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6835
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006836 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6837
6838
6839option tcp-smart-connect
6840no option tcp-smart-connect
6841 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 yes | no | yes | yes
6844 Arguments : none
6845
6846 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6847 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6848 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6849 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6850 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6851
6852 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6853 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6854 complex.
6855
6856 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6857 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6858 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6859
6860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6862
6863 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6864
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006865
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006866option tcpka
6867 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6869 yes | yes | yes | yes
6870 Arguments : none
6871
6872 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6873 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6874 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6875 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6876
6877 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6878 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6879 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6880 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6881
6882 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6883 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6884 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6885 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6886 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6887
6888 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6889
6890 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6891 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6892 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6893 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6894 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6895 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6896 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6897 backends.
6898
6899 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6900
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006901
6902option tcplog
6903 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6905 yes | yes | yes | yes
6906 Arguments : none
6907
6908 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6909 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6910 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6911 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6912 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6913 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6914 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6915 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6916
6917 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6918
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006919 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006921 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006922
6923
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006924option transparent
6925no option transparent
6926 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006928 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006929 Arguments : none
6930
6931 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6932 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6933 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6934 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6935 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6936 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6937 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6938 appropriate server.
6939
6940 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6941 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6942
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006943 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006944 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006945
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006946
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006947external-check command <command>
6948 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
6951
6952 Arguments :
6953 <command> is the external command to run
6954
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006955 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6956
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006957 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006958
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006959 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6960 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6961 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6962 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6963 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6964 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006965
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006966 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6967
6968 Environment variables :
6969 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6970 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6971
6972 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6973
6974 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6975
6976 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6977 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6978 for a UNIX socket).
6979
6980 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6981
6982 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6983
6984 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6985
6986 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6987
6988 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6989
6990 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6991 socket).
6992
6993 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6994 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6995
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006996 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6997 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6998 failed.
6999
7000 Example :
7001 external-check command /bin/true
7002
7003 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7004
7005
7006external-check path <path>
7007 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7009 yes | no | yes | yes
7010
7011 Arguments :
7012 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7013
7014 The default path is "".
7015
7016 Example :
7017 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7018
7019 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7020 "external-check command"
7021
7022
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007023persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007024persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007025 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7027 yes | no | yes | yes
7028 Arguments :
7029 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007030 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7031 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007032
7033 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7034 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
7035 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
7036 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7037 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7038 forwarded to this server.
7039
7040 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7041 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7042 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007043 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007044 a single "listen" section.
7045
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007046 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7047 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7048 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7049
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007050 Example :
7051 listen tse-farm
7052 bind :3389
7053 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7054 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7055 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7056 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7057 persist rdp-cookie
7058 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007059 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007060 balance rdp-cookie
7061 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7062 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7063
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007064 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7065 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007066
7067
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007068rate-limit sessions <rate>
7069 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7071 yes | yes | yes | no
7072 Arguments :
7073 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7074 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7075
7076 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7077 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7078 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7079 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7080 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7081 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7082
7083 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7084 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7085 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7086 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7087
7088 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7089 listen smtp
7090 mode tcp
7091 bind :25
7092 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007093 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007094
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007095 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7096 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7097 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007098
7099 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7100
7101
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007102redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7103redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7104redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007105 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7107 no | yes | yes | yes
7108
7109 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007110 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007111
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007112 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007113 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007114 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7115 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7116 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007117
7118 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7119 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7120 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7121 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7122 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007123 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7124 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7125 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7126 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007127
7128 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7129 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7130 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7131 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7132 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7133 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007134 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007135 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007136 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7137 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7138 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007139
7140 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007141 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7142 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7143 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007144 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007145 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7146 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7147 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7148 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007149
7150 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7151 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7152
7153 - "drop-query"
7154 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7155 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7156 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7157 with a location-type redirect.
7158
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007159 - "append-slash"
7160 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7161 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7162 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7163 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7164
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007165 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7166 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7167 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7168 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7169 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7170 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7171 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7172
7173 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7174 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7175 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7176 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7177 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7178 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7179 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007180
7181 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7182 acl clear dst_port 80
7183 acl secure dst_port 8080
7184 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007185 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007186 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007187 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7188
7189 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007190 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7191 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7192 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007193 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007194
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007195 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7196 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7197 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7198
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007199 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007200 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007201
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007202 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007203 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7204 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7205 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007207 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007208
7209
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007210redisp (deprecated)
7211redispatch (deprecated)
7212 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7213 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7214 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007215 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007216
7217 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7218 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7219 be able to access the service anymore.
7220
7221 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7222 redistribute them to a working server.
7223
7224 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7225 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7226 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007228 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7229 "option redispatch" instead.
7230
7231 See also : "option redispatch"
7232
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007233
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007234reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007235 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7237 no | yes | yes | yes
7238 Arguments :
7239 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7240 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007241 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007242
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007243 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7244 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7245
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007246 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7247 the last header of an HTTP request.
7248
7249 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7250 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7251 responses.
7252
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007253 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7254 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7255 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7256
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007257 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7258 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007259
7260
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007261reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7262reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007263 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7265 no | yes | yes | yes
7266 Arguments :
7267 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7268 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7269 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7270 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7271 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7272 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7273 ignores case.
7274
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007275 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7276 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7277
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007278 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7279 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7280 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7281 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007282 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007283
7284 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7285 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7286
7287 Example :
7288 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7289 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7290 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7291
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007292 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7293 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294
7295
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007296reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7297reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007298 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7300 no | yes | yes | yes
7301 Arguments :
7302 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7303 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7304 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7305 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7306 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7307 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7308
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007309 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7310 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7311
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007312 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7313 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7314 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7315 next servers.
7316
7317 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7318 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7319 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7320
7321 Example :
7322 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7323 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7324 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7325
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007326 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7327 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007328
7329
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007330reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7331reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007332 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 no | yes | yes | yes
7335 Arguments :
7336 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7337 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7338 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7339 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7340 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7341 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7342 case.
7343
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007344 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7345 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7346
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007347 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7348 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7349 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7350 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007351 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007352
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007353 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007354 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007355 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007356
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007357 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7358 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7359
7360 Example :
7361 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7362 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7363 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7364
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007365 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7366 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007367
7368
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007369reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7370reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007371 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7373 no | yes | yes | yes
7374 Arguments :
7375 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7376 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7377 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7378 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7379 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7380 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7381 case.
7382
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007383 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7384 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7385
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007386 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7387 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7388 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7389 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7390
7391 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7392 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7393
7394 Example :
7395 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7396 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7397 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7398 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7399
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007400 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7401 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007402
7403
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007404reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7405reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007406 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 no | yes | yes | yes
7409 Arguments :
7410 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7411 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7412 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7413 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7414 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7415 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7416
7417 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7418 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7419 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7420 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007421 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007422
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007423 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7424 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7425
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007426 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7427 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7428 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7429
7430 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7431 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7432 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7433 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7434 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7435
7436 Example :
7437 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007438 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007439 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7440 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7441
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007442 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7443 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007444
7445
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007446reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7447reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007448 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7450 no | yes | yes | yes
7451 Arguments :
7452 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7453 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7454 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7455 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7456 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7457 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7458 ignores case.
7459
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007460 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7461 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7462
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007463 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7464 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007465 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7466 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7467 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007468 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7469 not set.
7470
7471 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7472 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7473 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7474 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7475 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7476
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007477 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007478 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7479 # block all others.
7480 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7481 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7482
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007483 # block bad guys
7484 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7485 reqitarpit . if badguys
7486
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007487 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7488 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007489
7490
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007491retries <value>
7492 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7493 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7494 yes | no | yes | yes
7495 Arguments :
7496 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7497 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7498 default value is 3.
7499
7500 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7501 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7502 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7503
7504 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007505 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7506 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007507
7508 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7509 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7510
7511 See also : "option redispatch"
7512
7513
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007514rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007515 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7517 no | yes | yes | yes
7518 Arguments :
7519 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7520 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007521 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007522
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007523 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7524 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7525
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007526 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7527 the last header of an HTTP response.
7528
7529 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7530 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7531 responses.
7532
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007533 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7534 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007535
7536
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007537rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7538rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007539 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7541 no | yes | yes | yes
7542 Arguments :
7543 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7544 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7545 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7546 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7547 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7548 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7549 ignores case.
7550
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007551 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7552 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7553
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007554 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7555 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007556 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007557 client.
7558
7559 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7560 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7561 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7562
7563 Example :
7564 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007565 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007566
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007567 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7568 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007569
7570
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007571rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7572rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007573 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7575 no | yes | yes | yes
7576 Arguments :
7577 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7578 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7579 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7580 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7581 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7582 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7583 ignores case.
7584
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007585 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7586 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7587
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007588 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7589 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7590 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7591 case-sensitive.
7592
7593 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007594 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7595 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7596 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007597
7598 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7599 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7600
7601 Example :
7602 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7603 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7604
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007605 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7606 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007607
7608
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007609rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7610rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007611 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7613 no | yes | yes | yes
7614 Arguments :
7615 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7616 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7617 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7618 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7619 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7620 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7621 ignores case.
7622
7623 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7624 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7625 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7626 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007627 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007628
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007629 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7630 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7631
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007632 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7633 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7634 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7635
7636 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7637 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7638 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7639 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7640 are not case-sensitive.
7641
7642 Example :
7643 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7644 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7645
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007646 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7647 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007648
7649
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007650server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007651 Declare a server in a backend
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 no | no | yes | yes
7654 Arguments :
7655 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007656 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007657 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007658
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007659 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7660 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7661 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7662 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007663 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7664 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7665 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7666 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7667 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007668 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7669 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7670 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7671 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7672 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7673 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7674 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007675 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007676 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7677 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007678 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7679 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007680
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007681 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007682 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7683 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7684 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7685 adding this value to the client's port.
7686
7687 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7688 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007689 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007690
7691 Examples :
7692 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7693 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007694 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007695 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7696 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7697 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007698
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007699 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7700 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7701 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7702 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7703 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7704
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007705 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7706 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007707
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007708server-state-file-name [<file>]
7709 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7710 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7711 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7712 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7713 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7714 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7715
7716 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7717 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7718
7719 global
7720 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7721
7722 backend bk
7723 load-server-state-from-file
7724
7725 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7726 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007727
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007728server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7729 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7730 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 no | no | yes | yes
7733
7734 Arguments:
7735 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7736
7737 <num | range>
7738 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7739 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7740 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7741 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7742
7743 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7744
7745 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7746
7747 <params*>
7748 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7749 keyword.
7750
7751 Examples:
7752 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7753 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7754 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7755
7756 # or
7757 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7758
7759 # would be equivalent to:
7760 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7761 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7762 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7763
7764
7765
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007766source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007767source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007768source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007769 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7771 yes | no | yes | yes
7772 Arguments :
7773 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7774 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007775
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007776 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007777 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7778 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7779 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7780 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7781 supported prefixes are :
7782 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7783 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7784 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007785 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007786 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7787 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007788
7789 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7790 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007791 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7792 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7793 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007794
7795 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7796 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7797 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7798 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7799 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7800 <addr>.
7801
7802 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7803 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7804 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7805 port.
7806
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007807 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7808 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7809 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7810 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007811 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007812 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7813 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7814 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7815 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7816 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7817 HTTP header.
7818
7819 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7820 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007821 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007822 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7823 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7824 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7825 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7826 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7827 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7828 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7829
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007830 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7831 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7832 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7833 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7834 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7835 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7836
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007837 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7838 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7839 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7840 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7841
7842 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7843 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7844 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7845 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7846 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7847 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7848
7849 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7850 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7851 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7852 there are two methods :
7853
7854 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7855 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7856 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7857 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7858 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7859 of the client ranges may be used.
7860
7861 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7862 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7863 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7864 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7865 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7866 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7867 same session.
7868
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007869 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7870 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7871 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007872 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007873
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007874 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7875
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007876 Examples :
7877 backend private
7878 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7879 source 192.168.1.200
7880
7881 backend transparent_ssl1
7882 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7883 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7884
7885 backend transparent_ssl2
7886 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7887 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7888 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7889
7890 backend transparent_ssl3
7891 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7892 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7893 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7894
7895 backend transparent_smtp
7896 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7897 # with Tproxy version 4.
7898 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7899
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007900 backend transparent_http
7901 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7902 # proxy.
7903 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007905 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007906 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7907
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007908
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007909srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7910 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7912 yes | no | yes | yes
7913 Arguments :
7914 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7915 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7916 as explained at the top of this document.
7917
7918 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7919 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7920 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7921 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7922 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7923 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7924 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7925
7926 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7927 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7928 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7929 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7930 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007931 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007932 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007933 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007934
7935 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7936 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7937 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7938 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7939 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7940 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7941
7942 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7943 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7944
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007945 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7946 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007947
7948
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007949stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7950 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007952 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007953
7954 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7955 matched.
7956
7957 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7958 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7959
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007960 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7961 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7962 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7963
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007964 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7965 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7966 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7967 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007968
7969 Example :
7970 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7971 backend stats_localhost
7972 stats enable
7973 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7974
7975 Example :
7976 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7977 backend stats_auth
7978 stats enable
7979 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7980 stats admin if TRUE
7981
7982 Example :
7983 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7984 userlist stats-auth
7985 group admin users admin
7986 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7987 group readonly users haproxy
7988 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7989
7990 backend stats_auth
7991 stats enable
7992 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7993 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7994 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7995 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7996
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007997 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7998 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7999 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008000
8001
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008002stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8003 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008005 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008006 Arguments :
8007 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8008
8009 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8010
8011 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8012 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8013 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8014 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8015 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8016 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8017
8018 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8019 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8020 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008021 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008022
8023 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8024 report using "stats scope".
8025
8026 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8027 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8028 unobvious parameters.
8029
8030 Example :
8031 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8032 backend public_www
8033 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8034 stats enable
8035 stats hide-version
8036 stats scope .
8037 stats uri /admin?stats
8038 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8039 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8040 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8041
8042 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8043 backend private_monitoring
8044 stats enable
8045 stats uri /admin?stats
8046 stats refresh 5s
8047
8048 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8049
8050
8051stats enable
8052 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008054 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008055 Arguments : none
8056
8057 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8058 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8059 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8060 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8061 - stats auth : no authentication
8062 - stats scope : no restriction
8063
8064 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8065 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8066 unobvious parameters.
8067
8068 Example :
8069 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8070 backend public_www
8071 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8072 stats enable
8073 stats hide-version
8074 stats scope .
8075 stats uri /admin?stats
8076 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8077 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8078 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8079
8080 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8081 backend private_monitoring
8082 stats enable
8083 stats uri /admin?stats
8084 stats refresh 5s
8085
8086 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8087
8088
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008089stats hide-version
8090 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008092 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008093 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008094
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008095 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8096 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8097 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8098 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8099 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8100 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008102 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8103 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8104 unobvious parameters.
8105
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008106 Example :
8107 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8108 backend public_www
8109 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008110 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008111 stats hide-version
8112 stats scope .
8113 stats uri /admin?stats
8114 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8115 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8116 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008117
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008118 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8119 backend private_monitoring
8120 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008121 stats uri /admin?stats
8122 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008123
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008124 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008125
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008126
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008127stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8128 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8129 Access control for statistics
8130
8131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8132 no | no | yes | yes
8133
8134 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8135 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8136 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8137 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8138 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8139 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8140
8141 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8142 instance.
8143
8144 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8145 about ACL usage.
8146
8147
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008148stats realm <realm>
8149 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008151 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008152 Arguments :
8153 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8154 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8155 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8156
8157 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8158 using a backslash ('\').
8159
8160 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8161 only related to authentication.
8162
8163 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8164 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8165 unobvious parameters.
8166
8167 Example :
8168 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8169 backend public_www
8170 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8171 stats enable
8172 stats hide-version
8173 stats scope .
8174 stats uri /admin?stats
8175 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8176 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8177 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8178
8179 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8180 backend private_monitoring
8181 stats enable
8182 stats uri /admin?stats
8183 stats refresh 5s
8184
8185 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8186
8187
8188stats refresh <delay>
8189 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008191 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008192 Arguments :
8193 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8194 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8195 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8196 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8197 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8198 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8199
8200 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8201 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8202 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8203 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8204
8205 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8206 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8207 unobvious parameters.
8208
8209 Example :
8210 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8211 backend public_www
8212 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8213 stats enable
8214 stats hide-version
8215 stats scope .
8216 stats uri /admin?stats
8217 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8218 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8219 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8220
8221 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8222 backend private_monitoring
8223 stats enable
8224 stats uri /admin?stats
8225 stats refresh 5s
8226
8227 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8228
8229
8230stats scope { <name> | "." }
8231 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008233 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008234 Arguments :
8235 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8236 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8237 section in which the statement appears.
8238
8239 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8240 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8241 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8242 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8243 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8244 exists.
8245
8246 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8247 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8248 unobvious parameters.
8249
8250 Example :
8251 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8252 backend public_www
8253 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8254 stats enable
8255 stats hide-version
8256 stats scope .
8257 stats uri /admin?stats
8258 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8259 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8260 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8261
8262 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8263 backend private_monitoring
8264 stats enable
8265 stats uri /admin?stats
8266 stats refresh 5s
8267
8268 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8269
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008270
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008271stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008272 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008274 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008275
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008276 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008277 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8278
8279 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8280 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8281
8282 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8283 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008284 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008285
8286 Example :
8287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8288 backend private_monitoring
8289 stats enable
8290 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8291 stats uri /admin?stats
8292 stats refresh 5s
8293
8294 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8295 global section.
8296
8297
8298stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008299 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | yes | yes | yes
8302 Arguments : none
8303
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008304 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008305 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8306 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8307 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8308 - IP (socket, server)
8309 - cookie (backend, server)
8310
8311 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8312 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008313 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008314
8315 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8316
8317
8318stats show-node [ <name> ]
8319 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008321 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008322 Arguments:
8323 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8324 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8325
8326 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8327 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008328 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008329
8330 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8331 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8332 unobvious parameters.
8333
8334 Example:
8335 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8336 backend private_monitoring
8337 stats enable
8338 stats show-node Europe-1
8339 stats uri /admin?stats
8340 stats refresh 5s
8341
8342 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8343 section.
8344
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008345
8346stats uri <prefix>
8347 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008349 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008350 Arguments :
8351 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8352 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8353 query string.
8354
8355 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8356 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8357 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8358 possible to reach it in the application.
8359
8360 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008361 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008362 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8363 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8364 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8365 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8366
8367 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8368 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8369 an address or a port to statistics only.
8370
8371 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8372 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8373 unobvious parameters.
8374
8375 Example :
8376 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8377 backend public_www
8378 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8379 stats enable
8380 stats hide-version
8381 stats scope .
8382 stats uri /admin?stats
8383 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8384 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8385 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8386
8387 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8388 backend private_monitoring
8389 stats enable
8390 stats uri /admin?stats
8391 stats refresh 5s
8392
8393 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8394
8395
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008396stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8397 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008399 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008400
8401 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008402 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008403 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8404 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8405 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8406
8407 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8408 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8409 the "stick-table" statement.
8410
8411 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8412 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8413 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8414 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8415 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8416
8417 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8418 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8419 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8420 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8421 transformation rules.
8422
8423 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8424 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8425 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8426 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8427 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8428 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8429 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8430
8431 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8432 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8433 ACL based conditions.
8434
8435 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8436 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8437 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8438 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8439
8440 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8441 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8442 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8443 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8444
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008445 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8446 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8447 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8448
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008449 Example :
8450 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8451 # last 30 minutes
8452 backend pop
8453 mode tcp
8454 balance roundrobin
8455 stick store-request src
8456 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8457 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8458 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8459
8460 backend smtp
8461 mode tcp
8462 balance roundrobin
8463 stick match src table pop
8464 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8465 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8466
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008467 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008468 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008469
8470
8471stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8472 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 no | no | yes | yes
8475
8476 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8477 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8478 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8479 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8480
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008481 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8482 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8483 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8484
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008485 Examples :
8486 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008487 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008488
8489 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8490 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8491 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8492
8493
8494 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8495 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8496 backend http
8497 mode http
8498 balance roundrobin
8499 stick on src table https
8500 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8501 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8502 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8503
8504 backend https
8505 mode tcp
8506 balance roundrobin
8507 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8508 stick on src
8509 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8510 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008512 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008513
8514
8515stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8516 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8518 no | no | yes | yes
8519
8520 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008521 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008522 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8523 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8524 server is selected.
8525
8526 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8527 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8528 the "stick-table" statement.
8529
8530 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8531 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8532 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8533 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8534 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8535 address.
8536
8537 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8538 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8539 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8540 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8541 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8542 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8543 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8544 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8545 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8546 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8547
8548 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8549 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8550 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8551 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8552 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8553 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8554 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8555
8556 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8557 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8558 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8559 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8560
8561 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8562 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8563 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8564 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8565 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8566 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008567 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8568 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8569 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8570 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8571 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8572 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008573
8574 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8575 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8576 the request.
8577
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008578 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8579 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8580 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8581
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008582 Example :
8583 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8584 # last 30 minutes
8585 backend pop
8586 mode tcp
8587 balance roundrobin
8588 stick store-request src
8589 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8590 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8591 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8592
8593 backend smtp
8594 mode tcp
8595 balance roundrobin
8596 stick match src table pop
8597 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8598 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8599
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008600 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008601 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008602
8603
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008604stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008605 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8606 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008607 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008609 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008610
8611 Arguments :
8612 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8613 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8614 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8615 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8616
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008617 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8618 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8619 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8620 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8621
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008622 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8623 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8624 instance.
8625
8626 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8627 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8628 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8629 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8630 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8631 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008632 to 32 characters.
8633
8634 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8635 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8636 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008637 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008638 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8639 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008640
8641 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008642 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8643 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008644 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8645 increase.
8646
8647 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008648 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8649 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8650 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008651
8652 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8653 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8654 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8655 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8656 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8657 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8658 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8659 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8660 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8661 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8662 parameter (see below).
8663
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008664 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8665 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8666 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8667 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8668 soft restart.
8669
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008670 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8671 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008672
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008673 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8674 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8675 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8676 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008677 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008678 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008679 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8680 if not expiration delay is specified.
8681
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008682 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8683 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8684 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8685 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008686 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8687 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8688 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8689 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8690 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8691 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8692 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8693 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8694 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8695 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8696 types and their arguments.
8697
8698 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8699 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8700 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8701 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8702
8703 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8704 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8705 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8706 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8707
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008708 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8709 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8710 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8711 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8712 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8713 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8714
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008715 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8716 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8717 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8718 they were received.
8719
8720 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8721 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8722 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8723 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8724 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8725
8726 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8727 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8728 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8729 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8730 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8731
8732 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8733 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8734 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8735
8736 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8737 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8738 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8739 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8740 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8741
8742 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8743 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8744 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8745 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8746 the client side.
8747
8748 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8749 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8750 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8751 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8752 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8753 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8754 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8755
8756 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8757 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8758 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8759 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8760 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8761 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8762 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8763
8764 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8765 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8766 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8767 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8768 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8769 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8770
8771 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8772 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8773 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8774 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8775
8776 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8777 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8778 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8779 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8780 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8781 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8782 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8783 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8784 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8785 recommended for better fairness.
8786
8787 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8788 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8789 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8790 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8791
8792 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8793 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8794 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8795 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8796 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8797 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8798 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8799 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8800 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8801 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008802
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008803 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8804 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008805 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8806 reference it.
8807
8808 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8809 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008810 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8811 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8812 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008813
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008814 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8815 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8816 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8817 something that can be ignored.
8818
8819 Example:
8820 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8821 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8822 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8823 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8824
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008825 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008826 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008827
8828
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008829stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008830 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 no | no | yes | yes
8833
8834 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008835 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008836 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8837 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8838 server is selected.
8839
8840 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8841 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8842 the "stick-table" statement.
8843
8844 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8845 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8846 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8847 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8848
8849 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8850 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8851 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8852 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8853 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8854 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008855 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008856 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8857 rules.
8858
8859 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8860 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8861 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8862 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8863 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8864 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8865 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8866
8867 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8868 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8869 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8870 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8871
8872 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8873 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8874 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8875 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8876 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8877 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008878 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8879 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8880 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8881 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8882 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8883 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8884 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8885 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8886 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008887
8888 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8889
8890 Example :
8891 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8892 backend https
8893 mode tcp
8894 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008895 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008896 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008897
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008898 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8899 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8900
8901 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8902 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8903 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8904
8905 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8906 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008907
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008908 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8909 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8910 # at offset 44.
8911
8912 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8913 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8914
8915 # Learn on response if server hello.
8916 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008917
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008918 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8919 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8920
8921 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8922 extraction.
8923
8924
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008925tcp-check connect [params*]
8926 Opens a new connection
8927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8928 no | no | yes | yes
8929
8930 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8931 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8932 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8933
8934 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8935 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8936 of the sequence.
8937
8938 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8939 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8940 do.
8941
8942 Parameters :
8943 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8944 use the TCP connection.
8945
8946 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8947 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8948 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8949
8950 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8951
8952 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8953
8954 Examples:
8955 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8956 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8957 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8958 option tcp-check
8959 tcp-check connect
8960 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8961 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8962 tcp-check send \r\n
8963 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8964 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8965 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8966 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8967 tcp-check send \r\n
8968 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8969 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8970
8971 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8972 option tcp-check
8973 tcp-check connect port 110
8974 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8975 tcp-check connect port 143
8976 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8977 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8978
8979 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8980
8981
8982tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8983 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8984 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8985 no | no | yes | yes
8986
8987 Arguments :
8988 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8989 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8990 binary.
8991 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8992 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8993 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8994
8995 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8996 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8997 with the usual backslash ('\').
8998 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8999 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
9000 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9001 used upper or lower case.
9002
9003
9004 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9005
9006 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9007 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9008 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9009 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9010 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9011 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9012 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9013 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9014
9015 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9016 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9017 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9018 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9019 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9020 expression.
9021
9022 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9023 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9024 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9025 this exact hexadecimal string.
9026 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9027
9028 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9029 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9030 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9031 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9032 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9033 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9034 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9035 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9036 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9037 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9038 the null character.
9039
9040 Examples :
9041 # perform a POP check
9042 option tcp-check
9043 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9044
9045 # perform an IMAP check
9046 option tcp-check
9047 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9048
9049 # look for the redis master server
9050 option tcp-check
9051 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009052 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009053 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9054 tcp-check expect string role:master
9055 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9056 tcp-check expect string +OK
9057
9058
9059 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9060 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9061
9062
9063tcp-check send <data>
9064 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9065 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9066 no | no | yes | yes
9067
9068 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9069 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9070
9071 Examples :
9072 # look for the redis master server
9073 option tcp-check
9074 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9075 tcp-check expect string role:master
9076
9077 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9078 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9079
9080
9081tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
9082 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
9083 tcp health check
9084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9085 no | no | yes | yes
9086
9087 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9088 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9089 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
9090 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9091 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9092 hexadecimal string.
9093 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9094
9095 Examples :
9096 # redis check in binary
9097 option tcp-check
9098 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9099 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9100
9101
9102 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9103 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9104
9105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009106tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9107 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9109 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009110 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009111 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9112 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009114 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009115
9116 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9117 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009118 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9119 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9120 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9121 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9122 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9123 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009125 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9126 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9127 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9128 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009129
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009130 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009131 - accept :
9132 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9133 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9134 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009136 - reject :
9137 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9138 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9139 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9140 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9141 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9142 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9143 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9144 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9145 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9146 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9147 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009148 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009149
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009150 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9151 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9152 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9153 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9154 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9155 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9156 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9157 hosts.
9158
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009159 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9160 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9161 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9162 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9163 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9164 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9165 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9166 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9167
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009168 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9169 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9170 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9171 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9172 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9173 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9174 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9175 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9176 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009177 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9178 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009179
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009180 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009181 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009182 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009183 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009184 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9185 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009186 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009187 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9188 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9189 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9190 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9191 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009192
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009193 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009194 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009195 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009196 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9197 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9198 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9199 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009200
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009201 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9202 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9203 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9204 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009206 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9207 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9208 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9209 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9210 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009211 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9212 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9213 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9214 layer7 information is extracted.
9215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009216 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9217 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9218 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9219 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9220 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009221
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009222 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9223 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9224 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9225 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9226
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009227 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9228 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9229 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9230 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9231 continues.
9232
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009233 - set-src <expr> :
9234 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9235 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9236 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9237 set-src"
9238
9239 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9240 followed by some converters.
9241
9242 Example:
9243
9244 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9245
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009246 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9247 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009248
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009249 - set-src-port <expr> :
9250 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9251 expression.
9252
9253 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9254 followed by some converters.
9255
9256 Example:
9257
9258 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9259
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009260 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9261 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9262 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009263
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009264 - set-dst <expr> :
9265 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9266 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9267 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9268 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9269 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9270
9271 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9272 followed by some converters.
9273
9274 Example:
9275
9276 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9277 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9278
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009279 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9280 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9281
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009282 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9283 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9284 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9285 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9286
9287
9288 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9289 followed by some converters.
9290
9291 Example:
9292
9293 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9294
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009295 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9296 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9297 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9298
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009299 - "silent-drop" :
9300 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9301 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9302 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9303 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9304 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9305 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9306 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9307 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9308 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9309 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9310 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9311 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9312 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9313 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9314 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9315 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9316
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009317 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9318 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9319 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009321 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9322 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9323 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009325 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009326 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009327 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009328
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009329 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9330 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9331 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009332
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009333 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009334 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9335 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009336
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009337 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9338
9339 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9340
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009341 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9342
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009343 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009344
9345
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009346tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9347 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009349 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009350 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009351 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9352 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009353
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009354 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009356 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9357 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9358 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9359 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9360 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009361
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009362 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9363 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9364 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9365 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009366 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9367 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9368 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9369 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9370 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9371 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009372 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009373 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009374
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009375 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9376 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9377 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9378 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009379
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009380 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009381 - accept : the request is accepted
9382 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9383 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009384 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009385 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009386 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009387 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009388 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009389 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009390 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009391
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009392 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9393 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009394
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009395 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9396 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9397 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9398 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9399 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9400 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009402 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009403 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9404 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009405
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009406 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009407 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9408 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9409 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9410 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009411 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9412 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9413 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009414
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009415 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009416 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9417 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9418 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009419
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009420 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009421 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9422 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009423
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009424 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9425 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009426 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009427 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9428 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009429 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009430 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009431 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009432 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9433 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009434 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009435 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9436 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009437
9438 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9439 followed by some converters.
9440
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009441 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9442 <var-name>.
9443
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009444 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9445 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9446 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9447 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9448 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9449
9450 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9451
9452 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9453
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009454 Example:
9455
9456 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009457 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009458
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009459 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009460 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9461 # and reject everything else.
9462 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9463 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009464 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009465 tcp-request content reject
9466
9467 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009468 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9469 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9470 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009471 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009472
9473 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9474 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9475 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009476 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009477 tcp-request content reject
9478
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009479 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009480 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009481 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009482 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009483 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9484 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009485
9486 Example:
9487 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9488 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009489 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009491 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009492 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009493
9494 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009495 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009496 # protecting all our sites
9497 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009498 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9499 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009500 ...
9501 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9502
9503 backend http_dynamic
9504 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009505 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009506 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009507 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009508 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009509 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009510 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009512 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009513
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009514 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9515 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009516
9517
9518tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9519 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009521 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009522 Arguments :
9523 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9524 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9525 as explained at the top of this document.
9526
9527 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9528 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9529 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9530 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9531 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9532
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009533 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9534 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9535 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9536 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9537
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009538 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9539 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009540 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009541 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009542 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9543 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9544 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9545 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009546
9547 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9548 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9549 it pass through unaffected.
9550
9551 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9552 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9553 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009554 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009555 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9556 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009557 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9558 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9559 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009560
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009561 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009562 "timeout client".
9563
9564
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009565tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9566 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9568 no | no | yes | yes
9569 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009570 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9571 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009572
9573 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9574
9575 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9576 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9577 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009578 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9579 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009580
9581 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9582
9583 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9584 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9585 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9586 inserted.
9587
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009588 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009589 - accept :
9590 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9591 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9592 the rules evaluation.
9593
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009594 - close :
9595 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9596 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9597 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9598 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9599 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9600 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009601 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009602 protocols.
9603
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009604 - reject :
9605 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9606 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009607 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009608
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009609 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9610 Sets a variable.
9611
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009612 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9613 Unsets a variable.
9614
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009615 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9616 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9617 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9618 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9619
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009620 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9621 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9622 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9623 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9624 continues.
9625
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009626 - "silent-drop" :
9627 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9628 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9629 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9630 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9631 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9632 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9633 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9634 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9635 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9636 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9637 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9638 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9639 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9640 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9641 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9642 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9643
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009644 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9645 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9646
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009647 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9648 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9649 for changing the default action to a reject.
9650
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009651 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9652 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9653 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9654 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009655 period.
9656
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009657 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9658 declared inline.
9659
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009660 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9661 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009662 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009663 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9664 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009665 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009666 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009667 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009668 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9669 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009670 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009671 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9672 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009673
9674 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9675 followed by some converters.
9676
9677 Example:
9678
9679 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9680
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009681 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9682 <var-name>.
9683
9684 Example:
9685
9686 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9687
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009688 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9689 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9690 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9691 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9692 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9693
9694 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9695
9696 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9697
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009698 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9699
9700 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9701
9702
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009703tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9704 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9706 no | yes | yes | no
9707 Arguments :
9708 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9709 below.
9710
9711 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9712
9713 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9714 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9715 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9716 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9717 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9718 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9719 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9720 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9721 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9722 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9723 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9724 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9725 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9726 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9727 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9728 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9729 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9730 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9731 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9732 instead.
9733
9734 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9735 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9736 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9737 rules which may be inserted.
9738
9739 Several types of actions are supported :
9740 - accept : the request is accepted
9741 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9742 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9743 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9744 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9745 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009746 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009747 - silent-drop
9748
9749 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9750 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9751 sections for a complete description.
9752
9753 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9754 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9755 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9756
9757 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9758 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9759 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9760 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9761 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9762
9763 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9764 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9765
9766 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9767 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9768 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9769
9770 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9771 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9772 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9773
9774 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9775 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9776 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9777
9778 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9779 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9780 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9781
9782 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9783
9784 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9785
9786
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009787tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9788 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9790 no | no | yes | yes
9791 Arguments :
9792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9794 as explained at the top of this document.
9795
9796 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9797
9798
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009799timeout check <timeout>
9800 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9801 established.
9802
9803 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9804 yes | no | yes | yes
9805 Arguments:
9806 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9808 as explained at the top of this document.
9809
9810 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9811 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9812 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9813 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009814 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9815 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9816 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009817
9818 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9819 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9820
9821 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9822 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009823 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009824
9825 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9826 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9827 forget about it.
9828
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009829 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9830 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009831
9832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009833timeout client <timeout>
9834timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9835 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9837 yes | yes | yes | no
9838 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9841 as explained at the top of this document.
9842
9843 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9844 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9845 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009846 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9847 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9848 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9849 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009850 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9851 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9852 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009853 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009854 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009855 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9856 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009857 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9858 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009859
9860 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9861 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9862 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9863 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9864 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9865 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9866
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009867 This also applies to HTTP2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
9868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009869 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9870 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9871 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9872
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009873 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9874 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009875
9876
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009877timeout client-fin <timeout>
9878 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9880 yes | yes | yes | no
9881 Arguments :
9882 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9883 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9884 as explained at the top of this document.
9885
9886 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9887 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9888 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9889 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9890 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9891 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9892 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +01009893 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
9894 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
9895 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009896
9897 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9898 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9899 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9900
9901 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9902
9903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009904timeout connect <timeout>
9905timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9906 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9908 yes | no | yes | yes
9909 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009910 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009911 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9912 as explained at the top of this document.
9913
9914 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009915 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009916 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009917 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009918 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9919 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009920
9921 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9922 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9923 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9924 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9925 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9926 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9927
9928 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9929 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9930 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9931
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009932 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9933 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009934
9935
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009936timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9937 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9939 yes | yes | yes | yes
9940 Arguments :
9941 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9942 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9943 as explained at the top of this document.
9944
9945 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9946 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9947 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9948 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9949 once the request has started to present itself.
9950
9951 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9952 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9953 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9954 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9955 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9956
9957 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9958 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9959 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9960 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9961
9962 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9963 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9964 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9965 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9966 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009967 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009968
9969 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9970 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9971 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9972 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9973
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009974 When using HTTP2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
9975 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP2
9976 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
9977
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009978 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9979
9980
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009981timeout http-request <timeout>
9982 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009984 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009985 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009986 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009987 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9988 as explained at the top of this document.
9989
9990 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9991 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9992 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9993 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9994 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9995 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9996 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009997 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9998 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9999 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10000 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
10001 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010002 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10003 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010004
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010005 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10006 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10007 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10008 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10009 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010010 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010011
10012 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10013 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
10014 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
10015 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10016 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10017
10018 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010019 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10020 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10021 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010022
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010023 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010024 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010025
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010026
10027timeout queue <timeout>
10028 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10030 yes | no | yes | yes
10031 Arguments :
10032 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10033 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10034 as explained at the top of this document.
10035
10036 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10037 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10038 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10039 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10040 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10041
10042 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10043 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10044 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10045 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10046
10047 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10048
10049
10050timeout server <timeout>
10051timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10052 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10054 yes | no | yes | yes
10055 Arguments :
10056 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10057 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10058 as explained at the top of this document.
10059
10060 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10061 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10062 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10063 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10064 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10065 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10066 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10067
10068 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10069 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10070 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10071 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10072 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010073 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010074 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010075 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10076 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
10077 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10078 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010079
10080 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10081 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10082 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10083 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10084 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10085 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10086
10087 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10088 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10089 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10090
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010091 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010092
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010093
10094timeout server-fin <timeout>
10095 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10097 yes | no | yes | yes
10098 Arguments :
10099 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10100 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10101 as explained at the top of this document.
10102
10103 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10104 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10105 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10106 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10107 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10108 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10109 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10110 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10111 situations, it should not be needed.
10112
10113 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10114 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10115 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10116
10117 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10118
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010119
10120timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010121 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10123 yes | yes | yes | yes
10124 Arguments :
10125 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10126 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10127 as explained at the top of this document.
10128
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010129 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10130 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10131 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10132 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010133
10134 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10135 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10136 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10137 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010138 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010139
10140 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10141
10142
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010143timeout tunnel <timeout>
10144 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10146 yes | no | yes | yes
10147 Arguments :
10148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10150 as explained at the top of this document.
10151
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010152 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010153 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10154 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10155 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10156 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10157 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10158 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10159 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10160 specified.
10161
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010162 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10163 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10164 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10165 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10166 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10167 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10168 state.
10169
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010170 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10171 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10172 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10173 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10174 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10175
10176 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10177 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10178 forget about it.
10179
10180 Example :
10181 defaults http
10182 option http-server-close
10183 timeout connect 5s
10184 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010185 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010186 timeout server 30s
10187 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10188
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010189 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010190
10191
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010192transparent (deprecated)
10193 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010195 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010196 Arguments : none
10197
10198 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10199 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10200 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10201 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10202 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10203 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10204 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10205 appropriate server.
10206
10207 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10208
10209 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10210 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10211
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010212 See also: "option transparent"
10213
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010214unique-id-format <string>
10215 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10217 yes | yes | yes | no
10218 Arguments :
10219 <string> is a log-format string.
10220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010221 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10222 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10223 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10224 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010225
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010226 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10227 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10228 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10229 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10230 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10231 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10232 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10233 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010234
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010235 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10236 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010238 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010239
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010240 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010241
10242 will generate:
10243
10244 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10245
10246 See also: "unique-id-header"
10247
10248unique-id-header <name>
10249 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10251 yes | yes | yes | no
10252 Arguments :
10253 <name> is the name of the header.
10254
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010255 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10256 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010258 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010259
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010260 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010261 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10262
10263 will generate:
10264
10265 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10266
10267 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010268
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010269use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010270 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10272 no | yes | yes | no
10273 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010274 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10275 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010276
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010277 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10278 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010279
10280 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10281 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10282 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010283 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10284 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10285 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10286 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010287
10288 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10289 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10290 assign the backend.
10291
10292 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10293 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10294 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10295 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10296 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10297 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10298
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010299 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010300 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010301 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10302 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10303 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10304
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010305 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10306 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10307 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10308 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10309 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10310 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10311 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10312 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10313 cannot be forced from the request.
10314
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010315 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010316 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10317 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10318
10319 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10320 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010321
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010322
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010323use-server <server> if <condition>
10324use-server <server> unless <condition>
10325 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10327 no | no | yes | yes
10328 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010329 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010330
10331 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10332
10333 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10334 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10335 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10336
10337 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10338 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10339 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10340 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10341 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10342 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10343 matches will assign the server.
10344
10345 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10346 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10347 with the next rules until one matches.
10348
10349 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10350 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10351 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10352 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10353
10354 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10355 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10356 stripped.
10357
10358 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10359 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10360 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10361 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10362
10363 Example :
10364 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10365 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10366 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10367 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10368 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10369 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010370 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010371 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10372 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10373
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010374 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010376
103775. Bind and Server options
10378--------------------------
10379
10380The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10381depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10382settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10383written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10384described in this section.
10385
10386
103875.1. Bind options
10388-----------------
10389
10390The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10391as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10392no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10393parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10394while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10395provided immediately after the setting name.
10396
10397The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10398
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010399accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10400 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10401 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10402 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10403 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10404 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10405 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10406 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10407 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10408 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010409 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10410 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10411 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010413accept-proxy
10414 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010415 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10416 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010417 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10418 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10419 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10420 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10421 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10422 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10423 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010424 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10425 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010426
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010427allow-0rtt
10428 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10429 due to security considerations.
10430
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010431alpn <protocols>
10432 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10433 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10434 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10435 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10436 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10437 initial NPN extension.
10438
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010439backlog <backlog>
10440 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10441 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10442
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010443curves <curves>
10444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10445 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10446 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10447 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10448 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10449 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10450
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010451ecdhe <named curve>
10452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010453 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10454 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010455
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010456ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10458 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10459 client's certificate.
10460
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010461ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10463 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10464 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10465 error is ignored.
10466
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010467ca-sign-file <cafile>
10468 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10469 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10470 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10471 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10472 'generate-certificates' for details.
10473
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010474ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10476 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10477 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10478 'generate-certificates' for details.
10479
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010480ciphers <ciphers>
10481 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10482 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010483 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010484 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10485 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010486 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10487 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10488 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10489 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010490
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010491crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10493 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10494 to verify client's certificate.
10495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010496crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10498 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10499 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10500 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10501 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10502 file.
10503
10504 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10505 are loaded.
10506
10507 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010508 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010509 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10510 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10511 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10512 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10513 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10514 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10515 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010516
10517 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10518 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10519 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10520 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010521 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10522 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010523
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010524 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010525
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010526 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10527 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010528 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010529 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10530 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10531 clients).
10532
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010533 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10534 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10535 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10536 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10537 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10538 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10539 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10540 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10541 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10542 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10543 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10544 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10545 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10546
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010547 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10548 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10549 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10550 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10551 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10552
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010553 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10554 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10555 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10556 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010557
10558 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10559 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10560 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10561 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10562 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10563 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10564 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10565 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10566 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10567
10568 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10569
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010570 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010571 a cert bundle.
10572
10573 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10574 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10575 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10576 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10577 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10578 provide multi-cert support.
10579
10580 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10581
10582 Filename | CN | SAN
10583 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10584 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010585 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010586 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10587 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10588
10589 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10590 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10591 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10592 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010593 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10594 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10595 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010596
10597 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10598 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10599
10600 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10601 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10602 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10603
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010604crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10606 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010607 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010608 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010609
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010610crt-list <file>
10611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010612 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10613 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010614
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010615 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10616
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010617 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10618 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010619 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010620 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010621
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010622 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10623 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10624 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10625 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10626 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10627 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10628 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10629 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010630
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010631 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010632 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010633 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10634 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10635 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010636
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010637 crt-list file example:
10638 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010639 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010640 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010641 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010642
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010643defer-accept
10644 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10645 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10646 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10647 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10648 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10649 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10650 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10651 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10652 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10653 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10654 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10655
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010656expose-fd listeners
10657 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10658 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010659 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10660 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010661 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10662
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010663force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010664 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010665 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010666 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010667 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010668
10669force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010670 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010671 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010672 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010673
10674force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010675 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010676 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010677 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010678
10679force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010680 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010681 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010682 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010683
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010684force-tlsv13
10685 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10686 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010687 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010688
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010689generate-certificates
10690 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10691 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10692 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10693 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10694 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10695 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10696 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10697 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10698 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10699 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10700 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10701
10702 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10703 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10704 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10705 certificate is used many times.
10706
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010707gid <gid>
10708 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10709 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10710 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10711 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10712 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10713
10714group <group>
10715 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10716 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10717 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10718 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10719 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10720
10721id <id>
10722 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10723 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10724 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10725 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10726
10727interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010728 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10729 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10730 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10731 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10732 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10733 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10734 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010735
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010736level <level>
10737 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10738 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10739 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10740 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10741 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10742 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10743 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10744 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10745 counters).
10746 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10747 all counters).
10748
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010749severity-output <format>
10750 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10751 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10752 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10753 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10754 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10755 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10756 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10757 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10758 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10759 rfc5424 convention.
10760
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010761maxconn <maxconn>
10762 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10763 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10764 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10765 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10766 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10767 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10768 eat all memory.
10769
10770mode <mode>
10771 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10772 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10773 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10774 UNIX sockets.
10775
10776mss <maxseg>
10777 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10778 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10779 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10780 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10781 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10782 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10783 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10784 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10785 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10786 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10787 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10788
10789name <name>
10790 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10791 page.
10792
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010793namespace <name>
10794 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10795 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10796 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10797 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010799nice <nice>
10800 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10801 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10802 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10803 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10804 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10805 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10806 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10807 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10808 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10809 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10810 one for an RDP socket.
10811
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010812no-ca-names
10813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10814 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10815
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010816no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010818 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010819 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010820 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010821 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10822 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010823
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010824no-tls-tickets
10825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10826 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10827 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010828 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10829 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010830
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010831no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010833 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010834 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010835 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010836 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10837 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010838
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010839no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010841 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010842 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010843 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010844 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10845 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010847no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010849 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010850 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010851 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010852 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10853 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010854
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010855no-tlsv13
10856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10857 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10858 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10859 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10861 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010862
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010863npn <protocols>
10864 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10865 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10866 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10867 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010868 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10869 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010870
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010871prefer-client-ciphers
10872 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10873 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10874 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10875
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010876process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
10877 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
10878 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
10879 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
10880 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
10881 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
10882 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
10883 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
10884 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process inoming
10885 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
10886 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
10887 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
10888
10889 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
10890
10891 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
10892 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
10893 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
10894 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
10895 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
10896 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
10897 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
10898 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010900ssl
10901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010902 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010903 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10904 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010905 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10906 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010907
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010908ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10909 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10910 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10911 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10912
10913ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10914 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10915 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10916 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10917
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010918strict-sni
10919 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10920 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10921 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10922 See the "crt" option for more information.
10923
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010924tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010925 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010926 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10927 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010928 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010929 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10930 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10931 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10932 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10933 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10934 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10935 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10936
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010937tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010938 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010939 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10940 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10941 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10942 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10943 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10944 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10945 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010946 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10947 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10948 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010949
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010950tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10951 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10952 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10953 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10954 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10955 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10956 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10957 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10958 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10959 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10960 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10961
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010962transparent
10963 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10964 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10965 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10966 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10967 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10968 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10969 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10970 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10971 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10972 so check for support with your vendor.
10973
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010974v4v6
10975 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10976 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10977 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10978 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010979 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010980
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010981v6only
10982 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10983 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10984 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010985 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10986 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010987
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010988uid <uid>
10989 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10990 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10991 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10992 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10993 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10994
10995user <user>
10996 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10997 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10998 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10999 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11000 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11001
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011002verify [none|optional|required]
11003 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11004 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11005 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11006 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11007 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011008 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11009 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11010 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11011 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200110135.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011014------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011015
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011016The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11017which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11018arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11019settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11020after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11021Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11022address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011024 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011025 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011026
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011027Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11028keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011030The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011031
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011032addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011033 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011034 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11035 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11036 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11037 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11038 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011039
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011040agent-check
11041 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011042 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11043 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11044 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11045 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011046
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011047 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011048 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011049 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11050 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11051 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011052
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011053 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
11054 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11055 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
11056 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
11057 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
11058
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011059 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11060 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011061
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011062 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11063 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11064 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011065
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011066 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11067 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11068 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011069
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011070 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11071 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11072 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11073 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11074 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
11075 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
11076 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011077
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011078 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11079 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011080
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011081 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11082 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11083 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11084 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11085 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11086 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11087 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11088 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11089 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011090
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011091 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11092 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011093 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11094 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11095 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011096 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011097
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011098 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011099 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011100
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011101agent-send <string>
11102 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11103 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11104 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11105 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11106 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11107
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011108agent-inter <delay>
11109 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11110 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11111
11112 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11113 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11114 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11115 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11116 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11117 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11118 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11119 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11120 of backends use the same servers.
11121
11122 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11123
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011124agent-addr <addr>
11125 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11126
11127 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11128 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11129 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11130 hostname, it will be resolved.
11131
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011132agent-port <port>
11133 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11134
11135 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011137backup
11138 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11139 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11140 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11141 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011142 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11143 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011144
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011145ca-file <cafile>
11146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11147 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11148 server's certificate.
11149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011150check
11151 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011152 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11153 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11154 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11155 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11156 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11157 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11158 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011159 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11160 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011161 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11162 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011163
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011164check-send-proxy
11165 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11166 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11167 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11168 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11169 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11170 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11171 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11172
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011173check-sni
11174 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11175 over SSL.
11176
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011177check-ssl
11178 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11179 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11180 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11181 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011182 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011183 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11184 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11185 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011186 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11187 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011188
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011189ciphers <ciphers>
11190 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011191 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011192 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11193 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11194 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11195 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11196 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11197 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011199cookie <value>
11200 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11201 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11202 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11203 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11204 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11205 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11206 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11207
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011208crl-file <crlfile>
11209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11210 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11211 to verify server's certificate.
11212
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011213crt <cert>
11214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11215 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11216 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11217 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11218 certificate request.
11219
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011220disabled
11221 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11222 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11223 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11224 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11225 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011226 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011227
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011228enabled
11229 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11230 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11231 default value.
11232 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11233 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011235error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011236 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11237 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11238 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011240 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011242fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011243 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11244 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11245 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11246
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011247force-sslv3
11248 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11249 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011250 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011252
11253force-tlsv10
11254 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011255 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011256 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011257
11258force-tlsv11
11259 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011260 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011261 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011262
11263force-tlsv12
11264 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011265 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011266 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011267
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011268force-tlsv13
11269 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11270 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011271 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011274 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11275 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11276 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011277
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011278init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11279 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11280 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11281 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11282 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11283 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11284 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11285 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11286 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11287 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11288 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11289 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11290 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11291 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11292 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11293 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11294 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11295 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11296 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11297 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11298 historic behaviour.
11299
11300 Example:
11301 defaults
11302 # never fail on address resolution
11303 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11304
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011305inter <delay>
11306fastinter <delay>
11307downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011308 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11309 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11310 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11311 between checks depending on the server state :
11312
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011313 Server state | Interval used
11314 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11315 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11316 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11317 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11318 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11319 or yet unchecked. |
11320 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11321 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11322 | "inter" otherwise.
11323 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011325 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11326 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11327 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11328 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011329 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11330 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11331 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11332 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11333 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011335maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011336 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11337 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11338 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11339 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11340 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11341 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11342 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11343 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011345maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011346 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11347 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11348 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11349 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11350 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11351 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11352 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011354minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011355 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11356 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11357 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11358 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11359 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11360 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011361 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011362 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011363
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011364namespace <name>
11365 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11366 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11367 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11368 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11369
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011370no-agent-check
11371 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11372 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11373 default value.
11374 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11375 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11376
11377no-backup
11378 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11379 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11380 default value.
11381 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11382 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11383
11384no-check
11385 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11386 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11387 default value.
11388 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11389 "default-server" "check" setting.
11390
11391no-check-ssl
11392 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11393 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11394 default value.
11395 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11396 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11397
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011398no-send-proxy
11399 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11400 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11401 default value.
11402 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11403 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11404
11405no-send-proxy-v2
11406 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11407 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11408 default value.
11409 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11410 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11411
11412no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11413 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11414 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11415 default value.
11416 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11417 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11418
11419no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11420 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11421 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11422 default value.
11423 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11424 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11425
11426no-ssl
11427 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11428 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11429 default value.
11430 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11431 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11432
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011433no-ssl-reuse
11434 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11435 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11436 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11437 and for paranoid users.
11438
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011439no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011440 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11441 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011442 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011443
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011444 Supported in default-server: No
11445
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011446no-tls-tickets
11447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11448 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11449 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011450 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11451 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011452 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011453
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011454no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011455 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011456 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11457 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011458 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11459 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011460 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011461
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011462 Supported in default-server: No
11463
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011464no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011465 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011466 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11467 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011468 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11469 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011470 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011471
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011472 Supported in default-server: No
11473
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011474no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011475 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011476 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11477 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011478 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11479 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011480 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011481
11482 Supported in default-server: No
11483
11484no-tlsv13
11485 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11486 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11487 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11488 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11489 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011490 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011491
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011492 Supported in default-server: No
11493
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011494no-verifyhost
11495 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11496 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11497 default value.
11498 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11499 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011500
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011501non-stick
11502 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11503 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11504 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011506observe <mode>
11507 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11508 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11509 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11510 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11511 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11512 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011513 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011514
11515 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011517on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011518 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11519 Currently, four modes are available:
11520 - fastinter: force fastinter
11521 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11522 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11523 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11524 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11525
11526 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11527
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011528on-marked-down <action>
11529 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11530 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011531 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11532 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11533 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11534 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11535 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11536 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11537 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11538 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011539
11540 Actions are disabled by default
11541
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011542on-marked-up <action>
11543 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11544 Currently one action is available:
11545 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11546 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11547 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11548 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11549 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11550 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11551 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11552 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11553
11554 Actions are disabled by default
11555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011556port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011557 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11558 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11559 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11560 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11561 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11562 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11563
11564redir <prefix>
11565 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11566 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11567 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11568 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11569 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11570 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11571 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11572 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011573 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011574 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11575 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11576 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11577 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11578 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11579
11580 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11581
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011582rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011583 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11584 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11585 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11586
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011587resolve-prefer <family>
11588 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11589 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11590 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11591 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11592
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011593 Default value: ipv6
11594
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011595 Example:
11596
11597 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011598
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011599resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11600 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11601 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011602 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011603 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11604 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11605 configured network, another address is selected.
11606
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011607 Example:
11608
11609 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011610
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011611resolvers <id>
11612 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11613 hostname.
11614
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011615 Example:
11616
11617 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011618
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011619 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011620
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011621send-proxy
11622 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11623 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11624 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11625 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011626 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11627 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11628 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11629 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11630 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11631 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11632 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11633 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11634 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11635 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011636 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11637 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011638
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011639send-proxy-v2
11640 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11641 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11642 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11643 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011644 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11645 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11646 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11647 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011648
11649send-proxy-v2-ssl
11650 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11651 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11652 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11653 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11654 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11655 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11656 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011657 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11658 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011659
11660send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11661 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11662 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11663 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11664 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11665 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11666 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11667 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11668 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011669 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11670 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011671
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011672slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011673 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11674 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11675 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11676 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11677 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11678 parameters :
11679
11680 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11681 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11682
11683 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11684 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11685 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11686 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11687
11688 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11689 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11690 seen as failed.
11691
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011692sni <expression>
11693 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11694 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11695 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11696 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011697 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11698 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011699 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11700 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011701
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011702source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011703source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011704source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011705 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11706 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11707 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11708 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11709
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011710 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11711 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11712 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11713 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11714 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11715 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11716 server.
11717
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011718 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11719 specifying the source address without port(s).
11720
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011721ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011722 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11723 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11724 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11725 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11726 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11727 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011728 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11729 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011730
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011731ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11732 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11733 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11734 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11735
11736ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11737 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11738 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11739 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11740
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011741ssl-reuse
11742 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11743 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11744 default value.
11745 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11746 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11747
11748stick
11749 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11750 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11751 default value.
11752 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11753 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011754
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011755tcp-ut <delay>
11756 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11757 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11758 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011759 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011760 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11761 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11762 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11763 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11764 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11765 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11766 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11767 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11768 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011770track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011771 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11772 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11773 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11774 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011775 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11776
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011777tls-tickets
11778 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11779 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11780 default value.
11781 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11782 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011783
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011784verify [none|required]
11785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011786 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011787 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11788 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11789 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11790 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11791 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11792 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11793 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11794 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11795 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11796 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11797 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011798
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011799verifyhost <hostname>
11800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011801 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11802 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11803 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11804 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11805 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11806 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11807 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11808 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011809
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011810weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011811 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11812 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11813 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011814 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11815 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11816 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11817 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11818 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11819 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011820
11821
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118225.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11823-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011824
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011825HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11826using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11827configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011828This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11829can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11830workload.
11831This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11832resolution at run time.
11833Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11834carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11835
11836
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118375.3.1. Global overview
11838----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011839
11840As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11841different steps of the process life:
11842
11843 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11844 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11845 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11846
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011847 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11848 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011849
11850A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11851 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11852 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11853 resolution to know this new IP.
11854
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011855When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11856HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11857SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11858from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11859will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11860will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011861
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011862A few things important to notice:
11863 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11864 first valid response.
11865
11866 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11867 servers return an error.
11868
11869
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118705.3.2. The resolvers section
11871----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011872
11873This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011874HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11875contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011876
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011877When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11878uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11879is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11880answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11881
11882When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011883used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011884
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011885 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11886 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11887 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011888
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011889 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11890 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011891
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011892 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11893 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11894 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011895
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011896For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11897following scenarios are possible:
11898
11899 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11900 ignored
11901
11902 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11903 applied
11904
11905 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11906 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11907
11908 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11909 retries the query with a new type
11910
11911 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11912 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011913
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011914As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11915a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011916<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011917
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011918
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011919resolvers <resolvers id>
11920 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11921
11922A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11923
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011924accepted_payload_size <nb>
11925 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011926 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011927 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11928 by RFC 6891)
11929
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011930 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011931 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11932
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011933 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11934
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011935nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11936 DNS server description:
11937 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11938 <ip> : IP address of the server
11939 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11940
11941hold <status> <period>
11942 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11943 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011944 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011945 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011946 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11947 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11948 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11949
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011950 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011951
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011952resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011953 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11954 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11955 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11956
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011957resolve_retries <nb>
11958 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11959 giving up.
11960 Default value: 3
11961
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011962 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11963 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11964 type.
11965
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011966timeout <event> <time>
11967 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11968 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11969 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011970 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11971 other time applied.
11972 Default value: 1s
11973 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11974 have been received.
11975 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011976 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11977 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11978
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011979 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011980
11981 resolvers mydns
11982 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11983 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11984 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011985 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011986 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011987 hold other 30s
11988 hold refused 30s
11989 hold nx 30s
11990 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011991 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011992 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011993
11994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119956. HTTP header manipulation
11996---------------------------
11997
11998In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11999response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12000request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12001which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012002against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012003
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012004If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12005to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12006but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12007HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12008stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12009because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12010a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12011still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012013This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12014in section 4.2 :
12015
12016 - reqadd <string>
12017 - reqallow <search>
12018 - reqiallow <search>
12019 - reqdel <search>
12020 - reqidel <search>
12021 - reqdeny <search>
12022 - reqideny <search>
12023 - reqpass <search>
12024 - reqipass <search>
12025 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12026 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12027 - reqtarpit <search>
12028 - reqitarpit <search>
12029 - rspadd <string>
12030 - rspdel <search>
12031 - rspidel <search>
12032 - rspdeny <search>
12033 - rspideny <search>
12034 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12035 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12036
12037With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12038is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12039parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12040prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12041Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12042
12043 \t for a tab
12044 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12045 \n for a new line (LF)
12046 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12047 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12048 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12049 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12050 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12051
12052The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12053portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12054above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12055regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
120569 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12057is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12058
12059The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12060after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12061
12062Notes related to these keywords :
12063---------------------------------
12064 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12065 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12066 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12067
12068 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12069 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12070 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12071
12072 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12073 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12074 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12075 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12076 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12077
12078 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12079 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12080 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12081 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12082 useless headers before adding new ones.
12083
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012084 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012085 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12086
12087 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12088 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12089 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12090
12091 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12092 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012093 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012094
12095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120967. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12097----------------------------------
12098
12099Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
12100client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12101The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12102these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12103but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12104data called patterns.
12105
12106
121077.1. ACL basics
12108---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012109
12110The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12111content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12112from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12113simple :
12114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012115 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012116 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012117 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12118 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012120The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12121adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012122
12123In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012125 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012126
12127This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12128Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12129and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012130an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12131conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12132as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12133are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012134
12135ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12136'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12137which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12138
12139There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12140performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012142The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12143specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12144this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012145methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12146ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012147
12148Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12149 - boolean
12150 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12151 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12152 - string
12153 - data block
12154
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012155Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12156converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12157would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12158The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12159which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12160
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012161Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12162keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12163fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12164which are summarized in the table below :
12165
12166 +---------------------+-----------------+
12167 | Sample or converter | Default |
12168 | output type | matching method |
12169 +---------------------+-----------------+
12170 | boolean | bool |
12171 +---------------------+-----------------+
12172 | integer | int |
12173 +---------------------+-----------------+
12174 | ip | ip |
12175 +---------------------+-----------------+
12176 | string | str |
12177 +---------------------+-----------------+
12178 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12179 +---------------------+-----------------+
12180
12181Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12182matching method, see below.
12183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012184The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12185 - boolean
12186 - integer or integer range
12187 - IP address / network
12188 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12189 - regular expression
12190 - hex block
12191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012192The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12193
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012194 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12195 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012196 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012197 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012198 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012199 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012200 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012202The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12203read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12204if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12205lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12206will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12207beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12208a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12209lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12210exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12211
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012212The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12213parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12214ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12215a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12216check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12217
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012218The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12219socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12220file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012222Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12223loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12224
12225 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12226
12227In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12228the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12229case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12230as well.
12231
12232The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12233sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12234do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12235methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12236is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12237obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12238followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12239default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12240that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12241string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12242
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012243The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12244By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12245string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12246resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12247server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12248waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12249flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12250function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012252There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12253sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12254be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012255
12256 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12257 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012258 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12259 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12260 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12261 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012262
12263 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12264 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012265 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012266
12267 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012269
12270 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012271 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012272
12273 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12274 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12275
12276 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12277 binary or string samples.
12278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12280 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012282 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12283 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12284 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012286 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12287 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012289 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12290 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012292 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12293 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012295 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12296 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012297 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012299 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12300 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12301 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012302
12303For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12304request, it is possible to do :
12305
12306 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12307
12308In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12309buffer, one would use the following acl :
12310
12311 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12312
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012313On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12314possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12315
12316 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012318All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12319criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12320method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12321to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12322criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12323the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012325If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012326the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12327For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012329 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12330 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12331 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12332 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012333
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012334
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012335The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12336types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12337combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12338brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12339default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012341 +-------------------------------------------------+
12342 | Input sample type |
12343 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012344 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012345 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12346 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12347 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012348 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012349 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012350 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012351 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012352 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012354 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012355 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012356 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012357 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012358 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012359 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012360 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012361 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012362 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012364 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012365 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012366 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012367 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012368 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012369 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12370 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12371 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012372
12373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123747.1.1. Matching booleans
12375------------------------
12376
12377In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12378Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12379When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12380that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12381
12382Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12383return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12384"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12385
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123877.1.2. Matching integers
12388------------------------
12389
12390Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12391enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12392to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12393
12394Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12395matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12396lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012397
12398For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12399unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12400representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12401
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012402As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12403two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12404instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12405ranges and operators.
12406
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012407For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012408operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12409Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12410of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012411
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012412Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012413
12414 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12415 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12416 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12417 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12418 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012420For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012421
12422 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12423
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012424This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12425
12426 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124297.1.3. Matching strings
12430-----------------------
12431
12432String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12433different forms :
12434
12435 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12436 patterns ;
12437
12438 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12439 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12440
12441 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12442 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12443
12444 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12445 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12446
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012447 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012448 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12449 matches.
12450
12451 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12452 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12453 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012454
12455String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12456exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12457characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12458string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12459to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012460before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012461
12462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124637.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12464---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012465
12466Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12467they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12468possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12469passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12470the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012471the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12472match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012473
12474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12476-------------------------------------
12477
12478It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12479not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12480a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12481to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12482digits may be used upper or lower case.
12483
12484Example :
12485 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12486 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12487
12488
124897.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12490---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012491
12492IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12493netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12494within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012495host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012496difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12497at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12498does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12499parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012500
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012501The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12502abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12503
12504 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12505 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12506 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12507 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12508 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12509 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12510 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12511 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12512
12513Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12514192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12515
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012516IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12517Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12518trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12519IPv6 patterns.
12520
12521HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12522following situations :
12523 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12524 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12525 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12526 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12527 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12528 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12529 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12530 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12531 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12532 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012534
125357.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12536----------------------------------
12537
12538Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12539combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12540
12541 - AND (implicit)
12542 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12543 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012545A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012547 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012549Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12550indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012552For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12553"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12554requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12555is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12556
12557 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012558 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12559 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12560 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012561
12562To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12563and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12564
12565 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12566 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12567 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12568 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12569
12570 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12571 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12572 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12573 use_backend www if host_www
12574
12575It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12576expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12577be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12578the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12579
12580 The following rule :
12581
12582 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012583 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012584
12585 Can also be written that way :
12586
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012587 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012588
12589It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12590to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12591simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12592sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12593good use is the following :
12594
12595 With named ACLs :
12596
12597 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12598 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12599 monitor fail if site_dead
12600
12601 With anonymous ACLs :
12602
12603 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12604
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012605See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12606keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012607
12608
126097.3. Fetching samples
12610---------------------
12611
12612Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12613against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12614sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12615ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12616of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12617available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12618
12619This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12620Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12621compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12622deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12623
12624The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12625matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12626method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12627indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12628
12629As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12630when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12631mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12632the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12633ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12634
12635Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12636multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12637when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12638incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12639are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12640is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12641all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12642
12643Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12644 - name
12645 - name(arg1)
12646 - name(arg1,arg2)
12647
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012648
126497.3.1. Converters
12650-----------------
12651
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012652Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12653of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12654is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12655was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12656has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12657unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12658
12659These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12660sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12661the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12662support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012663
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012664A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12665support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12666supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12667(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12668bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012670The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012671
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001267251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12673 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12674 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12675 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12676 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12677 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12678
12679 Example :
12680 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12681 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12682 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12683 frontend http-in
12684 bind *:8081
12685 default_backend servers
12686 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12687 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12688
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012689add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012690 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012691 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012692 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12693 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012694 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012695 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12696 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12697 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12698 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012700 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012701
12702and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012703 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012704 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012705 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12706 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012707 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012708 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12709 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12710 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12711 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12712 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012713 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012714
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012715b64dec
12716 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12717 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12718
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012719base64
12720 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12721 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12722 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12723
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012724bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012725 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012726 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12727 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12728 presence of a flag).
12729
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012730bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12731 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12732 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012733 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012734
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012735cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012736 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12737 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012738
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012739crc32([<avalanche>])
12740 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12741 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12742 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12743 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12744 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12745 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12746 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12747 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12748 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12749 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12750 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12751
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012752da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012753 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12754 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12755 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12756 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012757 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012758 configuration language.
12759
12760 Example:
12761 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012762 bind *:8881
12763 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012764 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012765
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012766debug
12767 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12768 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12769 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12770
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012771div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012772 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12773 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012774 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012775 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12776 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012777 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012778 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12779 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12780 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12781 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12782 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012783 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012784
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012785djb2([<avalanche>])
12786 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12787 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12788 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12789 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12790 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12791 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12792 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012793 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12794 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012795
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012796even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012797 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012798 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12799
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012800field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12801 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12802 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12803 list of chars.
12804
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012805hex
12806 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12807 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12808 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12809 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012810
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012811hex2i
12812 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12813 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12814
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012815http_date([<offset>])
12816 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12817 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12818 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12819 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12820 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12821 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012822
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012823in_table(<table>)
12824 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12825 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12826 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12827 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12828 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12829
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012830ipmask(<mask>)
12831 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12832 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12833 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12834 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12835
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012836json([<input-code>])
12837 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12838 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012839 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012840 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12841 of errors:
12842 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12843 bytes, ...)
12844 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12845 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12846
12847 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12848 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12849 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12850 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12851 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12852 are :
12853 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12854 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12855 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12856 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12857 error ;
12858 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12859 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12860
12861 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12862 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12863
12864 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012865 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012866 capture request header user-agent len 150
12867 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012868
12869 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12870 GET / HTTP/1.0
12871 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12872
12873 Output log:
12874 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012876language(<value>[,<default>])
12877 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12878 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12879 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12880 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12881 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12882 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12883 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12884 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12885 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12886 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12887 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12888 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012889
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012890 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012891
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012892 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12893 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012894
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012895 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12896 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12897 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12898 use_backend spanish if es
12899 use_backend french if fr
12900 use_backend english if en
12901 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012902
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012903lower
12904 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12905 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12906 type. The result is of type string.
12907
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012908ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12909 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12910 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12911 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12912 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12913 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12914 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12915
12916 Example :
12917
12918 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12919 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12920 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12921
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012922map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12923map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12924map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12925 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12926 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12927 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12928 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12929 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12930 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12931 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12932 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012933
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012934 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12935 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12936 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012937
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012938 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012939 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012940
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012941 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12942 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12943 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12944 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012945 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12946 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012947 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12948 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12949 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12950 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12951 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12952 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12953 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12954 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012955 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12956 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12957 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012958 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12959 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12960 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12961 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12962 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012963
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012964 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12965 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12966 the corresponding match text.
12967
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012968 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12969 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12970 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12971 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12972 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012973
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012974 Example :
12975
12976 # this is a comment and is ignored
12977 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12978 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12979 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12980 | | | `---------- value
12981 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12982 | `---------------------------- key
12983 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12984
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012985mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012986 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12987 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012988 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012989 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012990 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012991 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12992 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12993 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12994 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12995 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012996 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012997
12998mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012999 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013000 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13001 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013002 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013003 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013004 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013005 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13006 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13007 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13008 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
13009 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013010 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013011
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013012nbsrv
13013 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13014 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13015 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13016 map lookup.
13017
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013018neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013019 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13020 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13021 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13022 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013023
13024not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013025 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013026 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
13027 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
13028 absence of a flag).
13029
13030odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013031 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013032 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13033
13034or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013035 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013036 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013037 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13038 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013039 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013040 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13041 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13042 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13043 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
13044 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013045 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013046
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013047regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013048 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13049 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13050 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13051 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13052 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13053 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13054 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13055 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13056 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13057 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013058 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13059 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13060 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13061 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013062
13063 Example :
13064
13065 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13066 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13067 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13068 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13069
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013070capture-req(<id>)
13071 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13072 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13073
13074 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013075 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13076 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013077
13078capture-res(<id>)
13079 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13080 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13081
13082 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013083 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13084 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013085
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013086sdbm([<avalanche>])
13087 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13088 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13089 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13090 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13091 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13092 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13093 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013094 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
13095 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013096
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013097set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013098 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
13099 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
13100 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013101 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013102 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13103 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013104 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013105 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13106 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013107 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013108 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013109
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013110sha1
13111 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13112 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13113
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013114sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013115 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13116 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013117 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013118 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13119 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013120 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013121 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13122 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013123 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013124 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13125 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013126 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013127 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013128
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013129table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13133 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13134 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13135 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13136
13137
13138table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13142 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13143 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13144 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13145
13146table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13147 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13148 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13149 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13150 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13151 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13152
13153table_conn_cur(<table>)
13154 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13155 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13156 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13157 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13158 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13159
13160table_conn_rate(<table>)
13161 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13162 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13163 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13164 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13165 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13166
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013167table_gpt0(<table>)
13168 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13169 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13170 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13171 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13172 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13173
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013174table_gpc0(<table>)
13175 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13176 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13177 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13178 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13179 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13180
13181table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13182 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13183 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13184 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13185 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13186 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13187 sample fetch keyword.
13188
13189table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13190 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13191 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13192 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13193 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13194 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13195
13196table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13197 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13198 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13199 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13200 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13201 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13202 keyword.
13203
13204table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13205 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13206 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13207 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13208 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13209 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13210
13211table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13212 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13213 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13214 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13215 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13216 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13217 keyword.
13218
13219table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13220 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13221 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13222 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13223 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13224 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13225 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13226 keyword.
13227
13228table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13229 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13230 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13231 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13232 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13233 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13234 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13235 keyword.
13236
13237table_server_id(<table>)
13238 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13239 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13240 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13241 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13242 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13243 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13244
13245table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13246 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13247 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13248 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13249 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13250 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13251 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13252 keyword.
13253
13254table_sess_rate(<table>)
13255 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13256 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13257 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13258 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13259 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13260 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13261 keyword.
13262
13263table_trackers(<table>)
13264 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13265 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13266 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13267 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13268 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13269 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13270 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13271 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13272 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13273 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13274
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013275upper
13276 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13277 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13278 type. The result is of type string.
13279
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013280url_dec
13281 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13282 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13283
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013284unset-var(<var name>)
13285 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13286 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13287 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13288 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13289 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13290 response),
13291 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13292 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13293 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13294 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13295
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013296utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13297 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13298 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13299 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13300 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13301 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13302 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13303
13304 Example :
13305
13306 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13307 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13308 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13309
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013310word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13311 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13312 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13313
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013314wt6([<avalanche>])
13315 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13316 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13317 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13318 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13319 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13320 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13321 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013322 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13323 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013324
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013325xor(<value>)
13326 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013327 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013328 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013329 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013330 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013331 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13332 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013333 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013334 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13335 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013336 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013337 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013338
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013339xxh32([<seed>])
13340 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13341 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13342 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13343 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13344 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13345 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13346 as cryptographically secure.
13347
13348xxh64([<seed>])
13349 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13350 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13351 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13352 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13353 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13354 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13355 as cryptographically secure.
13356
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013357
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133587.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013359--------------------------------------------
13360
13361A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13362not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13363"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13364The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13365
13366always_false : boolean
13367 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13368 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13369
13370always_true : boolean
13371 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13372 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13373
13374avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013375 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13377 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13378 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13379 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13380 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13381 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13382 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13383 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13384 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13385 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13386 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13387 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13388 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013391 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13392 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13393 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13394 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13395 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013397be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13398 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13399 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13400 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13401 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13402 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13403 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013404
13405 Example :
13406 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13407 backend dynamic
13408 mode http
13409 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13410 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013411
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013412bin(<hexa>) : bin
13413 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13414 of the string.
13415
13416bool(<bool>) : bool
13417 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13418 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013422 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13424 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013425
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013426 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013427 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013428 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13429
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013430 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13431 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013432
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013433 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013434 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013435 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013436 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13437 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013438 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013439 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013440
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013441 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13442 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013443 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013444 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013445
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013446date([<offset>]) : integer
13447 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13448 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13449 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13450 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013451 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13452
13453 Example :
13454
13455 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13456 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013457
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013458distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13459 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13460 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13461 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13462 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13463 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13464 list of supported tokens.
13465
13466distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13467 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13468 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13469 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13470 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13471 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13472 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13473 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13474 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13475 supported tokens.
13476
13477 Example :
13478 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13479 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13480 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13481 # send large files to the big farm
13482 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13483
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013484env(<name>) : string
13485 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13486 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13487 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13488 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13489 certain way.
13490
13491 Examples :
13492 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13493 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13494
13495 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13496 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13499 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013500 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13501 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013502 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13503 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13504 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13505 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13506 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013507
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013508fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13509 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13510 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13511 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013513fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13514 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13515 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13516 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13517 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13518 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13519 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13520 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13521 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013522
13523 Example :
13524 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13525 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13526 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13527 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13528 frontend mail
13529 bind :25
13530 mode tcp
13531 maxconn 100
13532 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13533 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13534 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13535 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013536
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013537hostname : string
13538 Returns the system hostname.
13539
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013540int(<integer>) : signed integer
13541 Returns a signed integer.
13542
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013543ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13544 Returns an ipv4.
13545
13546ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13547 Returns an ipv6.
13548
13549meth(<method>) : method
13550 Returns a method.
13551
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013552nbproc : integer
13553 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13554 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13555 and debugging purposes.
13556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13558 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13559 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13560 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013561 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13562 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13563 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013564
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013565proc : integer
13566 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13567 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13568 debugging purposes.
13569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013570queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013571 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13572 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13573 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013574 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13575 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13576 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13577 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13578 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13579
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013580rand([<range>]) : integer
13581 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13582 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13583 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13584 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13585 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013587srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13588 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13589 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13590 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13591 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13592 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13593 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13594 methods.
13595
13596srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13597 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13598 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13599 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13600 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13601 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13602 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13603 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13604
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013605srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13606 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13607 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13608 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13609 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13610 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13611 fetch methods.
13612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013613srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13614 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13615 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013616 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013617 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13618 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13619 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13620 overloading servers).
13621
13622 Example :
13623 # Redirect to a separate back
13624 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13625 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13626 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13627
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013628stopping : boolean
13629 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13630 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13631 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13632
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013633str(<string>) : string
13634 Returns a string.
13635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013636table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13637 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13638 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13639
13640table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13641 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13642 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13643 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13644
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013645thread : integer
13646 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
13647 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
13648 and debugging purposes.
13649
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013650var(<var-name>) : undefined
13651 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013652 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13653 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013654 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013655 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13656 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013657 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013661 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013662
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136637.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013664----------------------------------
13665
13666The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13667closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13668methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13669sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13670TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013671the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13672counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13673"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013674argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13675the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13676this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677
13678be_id : integer
13679 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13680 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13681
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013682be_name : string
13683 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13684 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013686dst : ip
13687 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13688 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13689 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13690 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13691 RFC 4291.
13692
13693dst_conn : integer
13694 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13695 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13696 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13697 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13698 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13699 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13700 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13701 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013702
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013703dst_is_local : boolean
13704 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13705 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13706 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13707 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13708 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13709 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13710 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13711 it only once per connection.
13712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713dst_port : integer
13714 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13715 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13716 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13717 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13718 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13719 an HTTP header.
13720
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013721fc_http_major : integer
13722 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13723 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13724 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13725
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013726fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13727 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13728 header.
13729
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013730fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13731 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13732 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13733 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13734 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13735 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13736 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13737
13738fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13739 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13740 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13741 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13742 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13743 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13744 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13745
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013746fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13747 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13748 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13749 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13750 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13751
13752fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13753 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13754 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13755 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13756 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13757
13758fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13759 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13760 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13761 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13762 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13763
13764fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13765 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13766 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13767 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13768 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13769
13770fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13771 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13772 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13773 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13774 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13775
13776fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13777 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13778 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13779 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13780 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013782fe_id : integer
13783 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013784 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013785 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13786
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013787fe_name : string
13788 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13789 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13790 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13791
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013792sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013793sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13794sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13795sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013796 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13797 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13798 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013800sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013801sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13802sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13803sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013804 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13805 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13806 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13807
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013808sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013809sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13810sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13811sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013812 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13813 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013814 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13815 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13816 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013817
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013818 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013819 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13820 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013821 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13822 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13823 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013824 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13825 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013827sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013828sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13829sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13830sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013831 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13832 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013834sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013835sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13836sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13837sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013838 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13839 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13840 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013842sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013843sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13844sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13845sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013846 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13847 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13848 See also src_conn_rate.
13849
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013850sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013851sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13852sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13853sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013854 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013855 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013856
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013857sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13858sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13859sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13860sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13861 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13862 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13863
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013864sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013865sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13866sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13867sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013868 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13869 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13870 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013871 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13872 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13873 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013874
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013875sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013876sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13877sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13878sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013879 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13880 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13881 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013883sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013884sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13885sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13886sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013887 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13888 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13889 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13890 src_http_err_rate.
13891
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013892sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013893sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13894sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13895sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013896 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13897 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13898 src_http_req_cnt.
13899
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013900sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013901sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13902sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13903sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013904 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13905 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13906 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13907 src_http_req_rate.
13908
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013909sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013910sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13911sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13912sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013913 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013914 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13915 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13916 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13917 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013918
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013919 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013920 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13921 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013922 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13923
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013924sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013925sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13926sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13927sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013928 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13929 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13930 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013931
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013932sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013933sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13934sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13935sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013936 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13937 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13938 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013940sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013941sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13942sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13943sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013944 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13945 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13946 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13947 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013948 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013949 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13950
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013951sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013952sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13953sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13954sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013955 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13956 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13957 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13958 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13959 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013960 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013961
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013962sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013963sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13964sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13965sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013966 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13967 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13968 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13969
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013970sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013971sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13972sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13973sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013974 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13975 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013976 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013977 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13978 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13980 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13981 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013983so_id : integer
13984 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13985 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13986 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988src : ip
13989 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13990 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13991 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13992 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013993 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13994 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13995 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13996 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013997
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013998 Example:
13999 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14000 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014002src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14003 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14004 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14005 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014006 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014008src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14009 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14010 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014011 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014012 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14015 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14016 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14017 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14018 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14019 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14020 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014021
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014022 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014023 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14024 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14025 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14026 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014027 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014028 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14029 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014031src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014032 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014033 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014034 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014035 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014038 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014039 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14040 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014041 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14044 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14045 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14046 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014047 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014049src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014050 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014051 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014052 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014053 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014054
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014055src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14056 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14057 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14058 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14059 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014062 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014064 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14065 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014066 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14067 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14068 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14071 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
14072 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014073 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014074 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014077src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14078 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14079 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14080 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14081 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014082 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14085 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14086 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14087 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014088 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014090src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14091 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14092 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14093 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014094 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014095 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014097src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14098 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14099 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14100 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014101 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14103 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014104
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014105 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014106 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014107 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014108 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014109
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014110src_is_local : boolean
14111 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14112 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14113 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14114 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
14115 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
14116 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14117 once per connection.
14118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014120 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14121 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14122 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14123 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14124 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014127 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14128 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14129 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14130 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14131 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014133src_port : integer
14134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14135 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14136 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14137 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014139src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14140 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014141 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14142 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14143 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014144 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014146src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14147 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14148 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14149 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14150 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014151 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014153src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14154 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14155 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14156 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14157 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14158 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14159 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14160 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14161 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014162
14163 Example :
14164 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14165 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14166 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14167 listen ssh
14168 bind :22
14169 mode tcp
14170 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014171 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014172 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014173 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175srv_id : integer
14176 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14177 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14178 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014179
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141807.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014183The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14184closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14185when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14186usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014187future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014188
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001418951d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14190 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14191 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14192 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14193 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14194 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14195
14196 Example :
14197 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14198 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14199 # the request.
14200 frontend http-in
14201 bind *:8081
14202 default_backend servers
14203 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14204 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14205
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014206ssl_bc : boolean
14207 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14208 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14209 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14210
14211ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14212 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14213 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14214
14215ssl_bc_cipher : string
14216 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14217 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14218
14219ssl_bc_protocol : string
14220 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14221 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14222
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014223ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014224 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014225 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14226 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014227
14228ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14229 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14230 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14231 if session was reused or not.
14232
14233ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14234 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14235 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014237ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14238 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14239 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14240 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14241 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14242 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14245 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14246 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14247 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14248 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014249
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014250ssl_c_der : binary
14251 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14252 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14253 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014255ssl_c_err : integer
14256 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14257 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14258 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14259 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14260 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14263 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14264 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14265 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14266 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14267 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14268 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14269 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14270 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272ssl_c_key_alg : string
14273 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14274 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14275 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014277ssl_c_notafter : string
14278 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14279 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14280 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282ssl_c_notbefore : string
14283 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14284 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14285 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14288 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14289 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14290 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14291 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14292 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14293 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14294 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14295 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297ssl_c_serial : binary
14298 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14299 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14300 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14303 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14304 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14305 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014306 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14307 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14308
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014309 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014310 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14313 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14314 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14315 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014317ssl_c_used : boolean
14318 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14319 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321ssl_c_verify : integer
14322 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14323 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14324 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14325 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014327ssl_c_version : integer
14328 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14329 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014330
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014331ssl_f_der : binary
14332 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14333 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14334 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014336ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14337 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14338 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14339 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14340 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014341 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014342 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14343 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14344 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014346ssl_f_key_alg : string
14347 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14348 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14349 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014351ssl_f_notafter : string
14352 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14353 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14354 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356ssl_f_notbefore : string
14357 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14358 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14359 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014361ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14362 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14363 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14364 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14365 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14366 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14367 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14368 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14369 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371ssl_f_serial : binary
14372 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14373 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14374 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014375
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014376ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14377 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14378 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14379 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14382 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14383 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14384 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386ssl_f_version : integer
14387 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14388 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14389
14390ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014391 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14392 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14393 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395 Example :
14396 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14397 listen http-https
14398 bind :80
14399 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14400 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14401
14402ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14403 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14404 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14405
14406ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014407 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14409 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14410 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14411 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14412 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14413 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14414 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14415 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014417ssl_fc_cipher : string
14418 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14419 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014420
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014421ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14422 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14423 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014424 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014425
14426ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14427 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14428 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014429 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014430
14431ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14432 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14433 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14434 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014435 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14436 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014437
14438ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14439 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14440 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014441 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014444 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14445 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014446 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14447 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14448 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14449 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014450
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014451ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14452 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14453 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14454 wait until the handshake happened.
14455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14457 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014458 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14459 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14460 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14461 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014462
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014463ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014464 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14465 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014467ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014468 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14470 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14471 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14472 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14473 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14474 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14475 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477ssl_fc_protocol : string
14478 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14479 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014480
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014481ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014482 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014483 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14484 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14487 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14488 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14489 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14490 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014492ssl_fc_sni : string
14493 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14494 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14495 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14496 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14497 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14498
14499 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14500 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14501 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014502 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14503 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14507 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14510 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14511 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014512
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145147.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14518sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14519only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14520For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14521be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14522can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14523sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14524for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14525content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14528 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14529 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14530 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014532payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14533 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14534 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14535 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014536
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014537req.hdrs : string
14538 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14539 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14540 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14541 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14542
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014543req.hdrs_bin : binary
14544 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14545 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14546 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14547 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14548 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14549 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14550
14551 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14552
14553 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14554 str: <int:length><bytes>
14555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014556req.len : integer
14557req_len : integer (deprecated)
14558 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14559 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14560 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14561 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14562 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14563 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14564 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14565 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14568 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014569 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14570 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14571 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14572 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014574 ACL alternatives :
14575 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014577req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14578 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14579 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14580 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14581 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 ACL alternatives :
14584 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014586 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014588req.proto_http : boolean
14589req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14590 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14591 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14592 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14593 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14594 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14595 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14596 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014598 Example:
14599 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14600 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14601 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014602 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014604req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14605rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14606 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14607 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14608 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14609 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14610 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14611 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14612 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014614 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14615 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14616 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14617 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14618 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14619 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621 ACL derivatives :
14622 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014624 Example :
14625 listen tse-farm
14626 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14627 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14628 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14629 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14630 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14631 persist rdp-cookie
14632 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14633 # This is only useful makes sense if
14634 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14635 stick-table type string size 204800
14636 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14637 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14638 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014640 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14641 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014643req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14644rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14645 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14646 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14647 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14648 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650 ACL derivatives :
14651 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014652
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014653req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14654 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14655 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014656 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14657 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14658 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14659 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14660 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14663req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14664 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14665 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14666 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14667 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14668 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14669 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14670 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014672req.ssl_sni : string
14673req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14674 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14675 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14676 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14677 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14678 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14679 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14680 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14681 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14682 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14683 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14684 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14685 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014687 ACL derivatives :
14688 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014690 Examples :
14691 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14692 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14693 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14694 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14695 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014696
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014697req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14698 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14699 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14700 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14701 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14702 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14703 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14704 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14705 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14706 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708req.ssl_ver : integer
14709req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14710 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14711 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14712 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14713 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14714 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14715 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14716 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14717 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14718 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014720 ACL derivatives :
14721 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014722
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014723res.len : integer
14724 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14725 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14726 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14727 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14728 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14729 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14730 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14731 content inspection.
14732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014733res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14734 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014735 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14736 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14737 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14738 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014740res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14741 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14742 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14743 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14744 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014747
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014748res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14749rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14750 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14751 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14752 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14753 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14754 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14755 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14756 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758wait_end : boolean
14759 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14760 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14761 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14762 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14763 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14764 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14765 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14766 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768 Examples :
14769 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14770 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14771 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14774 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14775 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14776 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14777 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14778 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14779 tcp-request content reject
14780
14781
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147827.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783--------------------------------------
14784
14785It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14786This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14787data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14788its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14789HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14790content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14791to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14792more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14793response are indexed.
14794
14795base : string
14796 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14797 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14798 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14799 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14800 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14801 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14802 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14803 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14804
14805 ACL derivatives :
14806 base : exact string match
14807 base_beg : prefix match
14808 base_dir : subdir match
14809 base_dom : domain match
14810 base_end : suffix match
14811 base_len : length match
14812 base_reg : regex match
14813 base_sub : substring match
14814
14815base32 : integer
14816 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14817 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14818 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014819 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14820 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14821 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014822
14823base32+src : binary
14824 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14825 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14826 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14827 per-URL counters.
14828
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014829capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14830 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14831 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14832 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14833
14834capture.req.method : string
14835 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14836 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14837 because it's allocated.
14838
14839capture.req.uri : string
14840 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14841 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14842 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14843 allocated.
14844
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014845capture.req.ver : string
14846 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14847 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14848 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14849
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014850capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14851 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14852 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14853 The first entry is an index of 0.
14854 See also: "capture response header"
14855
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014856capture.res.ver : string
14857 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14858 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14859 persistent flag.
14860
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014861req.body : binary
14862 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14863 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14864 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14865 the first chunk is analyzed.
14866
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014867req.body_param([<name>) : string
14868 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14869 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14870 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14871 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14872 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14873 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14874 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14875 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14876 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14877 given.
14878
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014879req.body_len : integer
14880 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14881 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14882 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14883 "option http-buffer-request".
14884
14885req.body_size : integer
14886 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14887 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14888 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14889 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14890 "option http-buffer-request".
14891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892req.cook([<name>]) : string
14893cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14894 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14895 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14896 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14897 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14898 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14899 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14900 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14901 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14902
14903 ACL derivatives :
14904 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14905 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14906 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14907 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14908 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14909 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14910 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14911 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14914cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14915 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14916 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14919cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14920 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14921 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14922 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14923 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014925cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14926 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14927 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14928 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14929 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014930 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014931 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14932 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14933 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14934 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014936hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14937 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14938 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14939 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14940 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014941 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014943req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14944 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14945 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14946 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14947 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14948 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14949 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14950 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14951 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14954 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14955 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14956 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14957 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014959req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14960 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14961 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14962 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14963 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14964 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14965 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14966 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14967 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014968 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14970 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972 ACL derivatives :
14973 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14974 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14975 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14976 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14977 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14978 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14979 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14980 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14981
14982req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14983hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14984 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14985 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14986 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14987 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14988 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14989 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14990 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14991 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14992 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14993
14994req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14995hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14996 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14997 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14998 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14999 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15000 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15001 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15002 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15003 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15004
15005req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15006hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15007 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15008 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15009 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15010 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15011 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15012 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15013 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15014
15015http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15016 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15017 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15018 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15019 basic auth is supported.
15020
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015021http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15022 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15023 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15024 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15025 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15027 basic auth is supported.
15028
15029 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015030 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15031 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15032 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15033 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034
15035http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015036 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15037 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015038 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15039 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015041method : integer + string
15042 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15043 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15044 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15045 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15046 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15047 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15048 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050 ACL derivatives :
15051 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053 Example :
15054 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15055 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15056 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015058path : string
15059 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15060 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15061 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15062 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15063 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
15064 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
15065 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015067 ACL derivatives :
15068 path : exact string match
15069 path_beg : prefix match
15070 path_dir : subdir match
15071 path_dom : domain match
15072 path_end : suffix match
15073 path_len : length match
15074 path_reg : regex match
15075 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015076
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015077query : string
15078 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15079 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15080 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15081 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015082 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015083 which stops before the question mark.
15084
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015085req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15086 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15087 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15088 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15089 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091req.ver : string
15092req_ver : string (deprecated)
15093 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15094 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15095 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015097 ACL derivatives :
15098 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015100res.comp : boolean
15101 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15102 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15103 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015105res.comp_algo : string
15106 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15107 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15108 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110res.cook([<name>]) : string
15111scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15112 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15113 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15114 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116 ACL derivatives :
15117 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015119res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15120scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15121 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15122 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15123 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15126scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15127 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15128 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15129 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15132 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15133 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15134 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15135 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15136 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15137 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15138 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15139 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15140 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015142res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15143 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15144 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15145 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15146 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15147 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015149res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15150shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15151 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15152 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15153 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15154 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15155 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15156 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15157 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15158 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160 ACL derivatives :
15161 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15162 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15163 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15164 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15165 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15166 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15167 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15168 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15169
15170res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15171shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15172 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15173 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15174 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15175 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15176 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15179shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15180 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15181 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15182 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15183 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15184 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15185 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015186
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015187res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15188 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15189 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15190 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15191 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15194shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15195 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15196 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15197 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15198 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15199 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15200 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202res.ver : string
15203resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15204 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15205 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207 ACL derivatives :
15208 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15211 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15212 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015213 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015214 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15217 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015219status : integer
15220 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15221 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15222 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015223
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015224unique-id : string
15225 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15226 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15227 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15228 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15229 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15230 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232url : string
15233 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15234 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15235 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15236 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15237 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15238 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15239 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241 ACL derivatives :
15242 url : exact string match
15243 url_beg : prefix match
15244 url_dir : subdir match
15245 url_dom : domain match
15246 url_end : suffix match
15247 url_len : length match
15248 url_reg : regex match
15249 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251url_ip : ip
15252 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15253 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15254 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15255 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15256 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15257 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15258 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260url_port : integer
15261 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15262 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15263 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15264 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015265
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015266urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15267url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015268 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15269 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015270 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15271 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15272 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15273 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015274 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15275 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015276 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15277 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279 ACL derivatives :
15280 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15281 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15282 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15283 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15284 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15285 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15286 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15287 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015288
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290 Example :
15291 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15292 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15293 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15294 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015295
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015296urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015297 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15298 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15299 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015300
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015301url32 : integer
15302 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15303 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15304 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15305 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15306 is an unsigned integer.
15307
15308url32+src : binary
15309 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15310 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15311 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15312
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153147.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015315---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015317Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15318every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015319order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015321ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15322---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015323FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015324HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015325HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15326HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015327HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15328HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15329HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15330HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15331LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015332METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015333METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015334METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15335METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15336METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15337METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015338METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015339METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015340RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015341REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015342TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015343WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15344---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015345
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153478. Logging
15348----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015349
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015350One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15351provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15352very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15353provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15354state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015355to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015356headers.
15357
15358In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15359about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15360send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15361
15362 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15363 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15364 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15365 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15366 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015367 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15368 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015369
15370The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15371allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15372as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15373while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15374real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15375delay.
15376
15377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153788.1. Log levels
15379---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015380
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015381TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015382source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015383HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15384in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15385track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15386syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15387about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015388
15389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153908.2. Log formats
15391----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015392
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015393HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015394and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15395slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15396options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015397
15398 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15399 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15400 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15401 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15402 extents.
15403
15404 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15405 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15406 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15407 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15408 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15409
15410 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15411 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15412 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15413 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15414 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15415
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015416 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15417 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15418 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15419 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15420
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015421 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15422
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015423Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15424specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15425field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15426servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15427always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15428identifier.
15429
15430Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15431 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15432 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15433 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15434 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15435
15436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154378.2.1. Default log format
15438-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015439
15440This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15441as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15442format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15443
15444 Example :
15445 listen www
15446 mode http
15447 log global
15448 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15449
15450 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15451 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15452 (www/HTTP)
15453
15454 Field Format Extract from the example above
15455 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15456 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15457 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15458 4 'to' to
15459 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15460 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15461
15462Detailed fields description :
15463 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15464 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15465 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15466 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15467 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15468 and processed the connection.
15469 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15470
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015471In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15472"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15473connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015475It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15476will eventually disappear.
15477
15478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154798.2.2. TCP log format
15480---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015481
15482The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15483is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15484information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15485counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15486emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15487environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15488the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15489sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015490specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15491not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15492fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15493marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015494
15495 Example :
15496 frontend fnt
15497 mode tcp
15498 option tcplog
15499 log global
15500 default_backend bck
15501
15502 backend bck
15503 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15504
15505 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15506 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15507 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15508
15509 Field Format Extract from the example above
15510 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15511 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15512 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15513 4 frontend_name fnt
15514 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15515 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15516 7 bytes_read* 212
15517 8 termination_state --
15518 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15519 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15520
15521Detailed fields description :
15522 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015523 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15524 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15525 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015526 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15527 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15528 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015529
15530 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015531 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15532 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15533 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015534
15535 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15536 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15537 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15538 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15539
15540 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15541 and processed the connection.
15542
15543 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15544 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15545 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15546 applications.
15547
15548 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15549 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15550 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15551 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15552 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15553
15554 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15555 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15556 See "Timers" below for more details.
15557
15558 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15559 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15560 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15561 "Timers" below for more details.
15562
15563 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015564 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015565 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15566 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15567 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15568 details.
15569
15570 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15571 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15572 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15573 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15574 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15575
15576 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15577 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15578 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15579 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15580 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15581 for more details.
15582
15583 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015584 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015585 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15586 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15587 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015588 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015589
15590 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15591 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15592 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15593 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15594 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15595 caused by a denial of service attack.
15596
15597 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15598 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15599 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15600 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15601 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15602 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15603 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15604 denial of service attack.
15605
15606 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15607 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15608 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15609 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15610 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15611 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15612 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15613 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15614 be processed than on other servers.
15615
15616 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15617 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15618 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15619 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15620 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15621 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15622 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15623 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15624 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15625 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15626 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15627 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15628 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15629
15630 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15631 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15632 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15633 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15634 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15635 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15636 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15637 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15638
15639 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15640 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15641 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15642 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15643 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15644 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15645 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15646 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15647 occurs.
15648
15649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156508.2.3. HTTP log format
15651----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015652
15653The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15654is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15655the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15656are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15657emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15658generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15659"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15660which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015661frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15662is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015663
15664Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15665slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15666with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15667
15668 Example :
15669 frontend http-in
15670 mode http
15671 option httplog
15672 log global
15673 default_backend bck
15674
15675 backend static
15676 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15677
15678 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15679 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15680 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015681 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015682
15683 Field Format Extract from the example above
15684 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15685 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015686 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015687 4 frontend_name http-in
15688 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015689 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015690 7 status_code 200
15691 8 bytes_read* 2750
15692 9 captured_request_cookie -
15693 10 captured_response_cookie -
15694 11 termination_state ----
15695 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15696 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15697 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15698 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15699 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015701Detailed fields description :
15702 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015703 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15704 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15705 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015706 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15707 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15708 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015709
15710 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015711 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15712 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15713 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015714
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015715 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15716 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015717
15718 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15719 and processed the connection.
15720
15721 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15722 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15723 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15724
15725 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15726 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15727 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15728 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15729 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15730 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15731
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015732 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15733 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15734 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15735 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15736 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15737 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15738 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015739
15740 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15741 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15742 See "Timers" below for more details.
15743
15744 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15745 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15746 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15747 below for more details.
15748
15749 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15750 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15751 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15752 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15753 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15754 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15755 for more details.
15756
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015757 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15758 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15759 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15760 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15761 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15762 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15763 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15764 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015765
15766 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15767 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15768 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15769
15770 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15771 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15772 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15773 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15774 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15775 overflowing.
15776
15777 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15778 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15779 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15780 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15781 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15782 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15783 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15784 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15785
15786 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15787 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15788 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15789 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15790 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15791 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15792 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15793 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15794
15795 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15796 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15797 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15798 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15799 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15800 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15801 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15802
15803 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015804 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015805 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15806 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15807 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015808 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015809 system.
15810
15811 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15812 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15813 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15814 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15815 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15816 caused by a denial of service attack.
15817
15818 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15819 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15820 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15821 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15822 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15823 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15824 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15825 denial of service attack.
15826
15827 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15828 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15829 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15830 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15831 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15832 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15833 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15834 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15835 processed than on other servers.
15836
15837 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15838 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15839 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15840 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15841 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15842 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15843 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15844 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15845 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15846 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15847 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15848 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15849 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15850
15851 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15852 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15853 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15854 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15855 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15856 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15857 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15858 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15859
15860 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15861 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15862 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15863 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15864 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15865 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15866 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15867 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15868 occurs.
15869
15870 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15871 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15872 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15873 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15874 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15875 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15876 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15877 cookies" below for more details.
15878
15879 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15880 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15881 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15882 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15883 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15884 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15885 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15886 and cookies" below for more details.
15887
15888 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15889 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15890 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15891 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15892 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15893 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15894 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15895 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15896
15897
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200158988.2.4. Custom log format
15899------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015900
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015901The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015902mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015903
15904HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15905Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15906separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15907prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15908
15909Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15910variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015911("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015912
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015913If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015914as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015915less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15916the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15917
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015918Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015919In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015920in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015921
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015922Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15923'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15924https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15925such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15926
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015927Flags are :
15928 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015929 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015930 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15931 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015932
15933 Example:
15934
15935 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15936 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15937
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015938 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15939
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015940At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015942 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15943 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015944
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015945the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015946
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015947 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15948 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15949 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015950
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015951and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15952
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015953 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15954 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015955
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015956Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15957
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015958 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015959 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015960 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15961 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15962 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015963 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15964 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15965 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015966 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015967 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15968 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015969 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015970 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15971 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015972 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015973 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015974 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015975 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015976 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015977 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015978 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015979 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15980 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15981 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15982 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15983 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015984 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015985 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15986 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015987 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015988 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15989 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015990 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15991 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15992 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015993 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015994 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15995 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015996 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015997 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15998 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15999 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016000 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016001 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016002 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16003 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16004 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16005 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016006 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016007 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016008 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016009 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016010 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016011 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016012 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16013 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16014 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016015 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016016 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16017 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016018 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016019 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16020 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
16021 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016022 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016023 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016024 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016025
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016026 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016027
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016028
160298.2.5. Error log format
16030-----------------------
16031
16032When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16033protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16034By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16035"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
16036will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
16037logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16038
16039The format looks like this :
16040
16041 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16042 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16043 Connection error during SSL handshake
16044
16045 Field Format Extract from the example above
16046 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16047 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16048 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16049 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16050 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16051
16052These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16053failures.
16054
16055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160568.3. Advanced logging options
16057-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016058
16059Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16060just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16061options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16062for more information about their usage.
16063
16064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160658.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16066------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016067
16068It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16069haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16070commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16071monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16072ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16073
16074 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16075 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16076 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16077 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16078
16079 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16080 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16081 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016082 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016083 such as other load-balancers.
16084
16085 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16086 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16087 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16088
16089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16091----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016092
16093The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16094what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16095or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
16096"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
16097just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16098log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16099after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16100is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16101with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16102with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16103
16104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16106------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016107
16108Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16109for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16110"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16111retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16112raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16113a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16114file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16115you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16116"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16117
16118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161198.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16120--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016121
16122Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16123multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16124them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16125"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16126logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16127error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16128and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16129too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16130useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16131alternative.
16132
16133
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161348.4. Timing events
16135------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016136
16137Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16138reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16139the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16140frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016141mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16142addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16143
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016144Timings events in HTTP mode:
16145
16146 first request 2nd request
16147 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16148 t tr t tr ...
16149 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16150 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16151 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16152 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16153 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16154
16155Timings events in TCP mode:
16156
16157 TCP session
16158 |<----------------->|
16159 t t
16160 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16161 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16162 |<------ Tt ------->|
16163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016164 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16165 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16166 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16167 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16168 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16169 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16170 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016171
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016172 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16173 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16174 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16175 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16176 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16177 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16178 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16179 nothing was received on the connection.
16180
16181 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16182 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16183 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16184 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16185 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16186 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16187 request typed by hand during a test.
16188
16189 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16190 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16191 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16192 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16193 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16194 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16195 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016196
16197 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16198 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16199 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16200 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16201 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16202
16203 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16204 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16205 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16206 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16207 connection never established.
16208
16209 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16210 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16211 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16212 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16213 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16214 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16215 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16216 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16217 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16218 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16219 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16220
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016221 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16222 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16223 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16224 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16225 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16226 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16227
16228 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16229
16230 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16231 "Ta" can never be negative.
16232
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016233 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16234 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016235 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16236 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016237 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016238
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016239 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016240
16241 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016242 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16243 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016244
16245These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16246protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16247that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016248due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16249"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16250that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016251
16252Most common cases :
16253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016254 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16255 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16256 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16257 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16258 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16259 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16260 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16261 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16262 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16263 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16264 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016265 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016266
16267 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16268 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16269 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16270 of ms on remote networks.
16271
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016272 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16273 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16274 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016275
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016276 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16277 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16278 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16279 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16280 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16281 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16282 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16283 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16284 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016285
16286Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16287
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016288 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016289 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016290 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016291
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016292 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016293 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16294 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16295
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016296 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016297 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16298 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16299 flags.
16300
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016301 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16302 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016303 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16304 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16305 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16306 the client connection was maintained open.
16307
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016308 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016309 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016310 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016311 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16312
16313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163148.5. Session state at disconnection
16315-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016316
16317TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16318"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
163192-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16320each of which has a special meaning :
16321
16322 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16323 session to terminate :
16324
16325 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16326
16327 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16328 server explicitly refused it.
16329
16330 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16331 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16332 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16333 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016334 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16335
16336 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16337 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016338
16339 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16340 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16341 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16342 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16343 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16344
16345 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16346 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16347 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16348 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16349 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16350
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016351 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16352 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16353
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016354 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16355 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16356 backup connections when going up.
16357
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016358 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16359
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016360 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16361 send or receive data.
16362
16363 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16364 send or receive data.
16365
16366 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16367 with nothing left in the buffers.
16368
16369 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16370
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016371 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016372 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16373
16374 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16375 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16376 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16377 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16378 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16379
16380 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16381 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16382
16383 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16384 server (HTTP only).
16385
16386 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16387
16388 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16389 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16390 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16391
16392 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16393 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16394 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16395
16396 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16397
16398 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16399 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16400
16401 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16402 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16403 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16404
16405 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16406 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016407 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16408 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016409
16410 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16411 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16412 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16413 another server.
16414
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016415 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016416 server.
16417
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016418 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16419 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16420 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16421 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16422
16423 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16424 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16425 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16426 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16427
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016428 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16429 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16430 "use-server" rule).
16431
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016432 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16433
16434 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16435 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16436
16437 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16438
16439 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16440 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16441 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16442
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016443 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16444 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016445 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016446 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16447 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16448
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016449 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16450
16451 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16452 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16453
16454 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16455
16456 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16457
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016458The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16459was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016460helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16461starvation, attacks, etc...
16462
16463The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16464alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16465easier finding and understanding.
16466
16467 Flags Reason
16468
16469 -- Normal termination.
16470
16471 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16472 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16473 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16474 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16475
16476 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16477 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16478 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16479 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16480 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16481 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016482
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016483 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16484 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016485 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016486
16487 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16488 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16489 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16490
16491 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16492 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16493 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16494 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16495 the server takes too long to respond.
16496
16497 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16498 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16499 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16500 long a time to respond.
16501
16502 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16503 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16504 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16505 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016506 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16507 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016508
16509 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16510 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16511 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16512 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16513 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016514 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016515 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16516 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16517 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16518 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16519 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16520 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16521 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16522 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16523 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16524 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16525 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16526 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016527
16528 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16529 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016530 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16531 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16532 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16533 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016534
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016535 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16536 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016538 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016539 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16540 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16541 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16542 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16543 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16544
16545 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16546 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16547 503 or 504 here.
16548
16549 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16550 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16551 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16552 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16553 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16554
16555 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16556 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016557 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016558 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16559 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16560
16561 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16562 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16563 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16564 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16565 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16566 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16567 between haproxy and the server.
16568
16569 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16570 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16571 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16572 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16573 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16574 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16575 solution is to fix the application.
16576
16577 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16578 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16579 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16580 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16581 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16582 external attacks.
16583
16584 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16585 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016586 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16588 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16589
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016590 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16591 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16592 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016593 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16594 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016595
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016596 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16597 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16598 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16599 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016600 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16601 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16602 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16603 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16604 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016605
16606 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16607 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16608 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16609 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16610
16611 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16612 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16613 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16614 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16615
16616 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16617 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16618 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16619 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16620
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016621The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16622persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16623important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16624re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16625
16626 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16627
16628 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16629 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16630 set on a GET request.
16631
16632 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16633 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016634 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016635 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16636
16637 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16638 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16639 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16640
16641 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16642 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16643 already got a cookie.
16644
16645 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16646 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16647 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16648 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16649 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16650
16651 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16652 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16653 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16654
16655 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16656 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16657 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16658
16659 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16660 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16661
16662 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16663 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16664 then advertised in the response.
16665
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166678.6. Non-printable characters
16668-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016669
16670In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16671consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16672converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16673prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16674being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16675escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16676is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16677'}' when logging headers.
16678
16679Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16680issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16681containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16682
16683Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16684the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16685performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16686
16687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16689---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016690
16691Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16692achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016693section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016694cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16695the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16696the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016697locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016698not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16699user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16700a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16701wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16702
16703 Examples :
16704 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16705 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16706
16707 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16708 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16709
16710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16712---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016713
16714Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16715proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16716the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16717server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16718
16719Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16720response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016721section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016722
16723It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016724time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16725appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016726are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16727and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16728follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16729request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16730in the logs.
16731
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016732As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16733frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16734an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016736 Example :
16737 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16738 listen proxy-out
16739 mode http
16740 option httplog
16741 option logasap
16742 log global
16743 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16744
16745 # log the name of the virtual server
16746 capture request header Host len 20
16747
16748 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16749 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16750
16751 # log the beginning of the referrer
16752 capture request header Referer len 20
16753
16754 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16755 capture response header Server len 20
16756
16757 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16758 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16759
16760 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16761 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16762
16763 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16764 capture response header Via len 20
16765
16766 # log the URL location during a redirection
16767 capture response header Location len 20
16768
16769 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16770 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16771 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16772 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16773 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16774
16775 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16776 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16777 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16778 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016779 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016780
16781 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16782 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16783 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16784 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16785 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016786 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016787
16788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167898.9. Examples of logs
16790---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016791
16792These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16793them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16794reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16795
16796 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16797 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16798 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16799
16800 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16801 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16802
16803 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16804 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16805 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16806
16807 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16808 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16809
16810 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16811 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16812 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16813
16814 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016815 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016816 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16817 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16818
16819 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16820 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16821 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16822
16823 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16824 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016825 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016826 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16827 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16828 to return the 502 and not the server.
16829
16830 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016831 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016832
16833 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16834 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16835 Nothing was sent to any server.
16836
16837 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16838 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16839
16840 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16841 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16842 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16843 send a 408 return code to the client.
16844
16845 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16846 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16847
16848 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16849 5 seconds ("c----").
16850
16851 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16852 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016853 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016854
16855 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016856 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016857 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16858 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16859 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16860 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16861 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016862
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016863
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200168649. Supported filters
16865--------------------
16866
16867Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16868accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16869unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16870
16871See also : "filter"
16872
168739.1. Trace
16874----------
16875
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016876filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016877
16878 Arguments:
16879 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16880 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16881
16882 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16883 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16884 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16885 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16886
16887 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16888 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16889 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16890 amount of the parsed data.
16891
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016892 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16893
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016894This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16895callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16896information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16897filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16898
16899Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16900tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16901a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16902
16903
169049.2. HTTP compression
16905---------------------
16906
16907filter compression
16908
16909The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16910keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16911when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16912use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16913used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16914filters evaluation order.
16915
16916See also : "compression"
16917
16918
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200169199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16920--------------------------------------------
16921
16922filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16923
16924 Arguments :
16925
16926 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16927 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16928 parsed.
16929
16930 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16931 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16932 part must be placed in its own scope.
16933
16934The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16935external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16936streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16937exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16938also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16939
16940SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16941the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16942
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016943For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016944"doc/SPOE.txt".
16945
16946Important note:
16947 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16948 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16949
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001695010. Cache
16951---------
16952
16953HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16954(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16955RAM.
16956
16957The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
16958this memory is splitted in blocks of 1k.
16959
16960If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16961independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16962when we try to allocate a new one.
16963
16964The cache use a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16965
16966It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16967"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16968for more details.
16969
16970When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16971replaced by "<CACHE>".
16972
1697310.1 Limitation
16974---------------
16975
16976The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16977
16978- If the response is not a 200
16979- If the response contains a Vary header
16980- If the response does not contain a Content-Length header or if the
16981 Content-Length + the headers size is greater than a buffer size - the
16982 reserve.
16983- If the response is not cacheable
16984
16985- If the request is not a GET
16986- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16987
16988Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
16989to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
16990if they modify the response (compression for exemple).
16991
1699210.2 Setup
16993----------
16994
16995To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16996the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16997
1699810.2.1 Cache section
16999--------------------
17000
17001cache <name>
17002 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17003 size of cache is mandatory.
17004
17005total-max-size <megabytes>
17006 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. this size is splitted in
17007 blocks of 1kb which are used by the cache entries.
17008
17009max-age <seconds>
17010 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17011 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17012 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17013 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17014 default.
17015
1701610.2.2 Proxy section
17017--------------------
17018
17019http-request cache-use <name>
17020 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17021 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17022 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17023 after this one.
17024
17025http-response cache-store <name>
17026 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17027 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17028 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17029 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17030
17031
17032Example:
17033
17034 backend bck1
17035 mode http
17036
17037 http-request cache-use foobar
17038 http-response cache-store foobar
17039 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17040
17041 cache foobar
17042 total-max-size 4
17043 max-age 240
17044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017045/*
17046 * Local variables:
17047 * fill-column: 79
17048 * End:
17049 */